mirror of
https://github.com/Sneed-Group/Poodletooth-iLand
synced 2024-12-29 06:32:40 -06:00
8573 lines
291 KiB
Python
8573 lines
291 KiB
Python
# --------------------------------------------------------------------------------- #
|
|
# CUSTOMTREECTRL wxPython IMPLEMENTATION
|
|
# Inspired By And Heavily Based On wxGenericTreeCtrl.
|
|
#
|
|
# Andrea Gavana, @ 17 May 2006
|
|
# Latest Revision: 09 Jan 2014, 23.00 GMT
|
|
#
|
|
#
|
|
# TODO List
|
|
#
|
|
# Almost All The Features Of wx.TreeCtrl Are Available, And There Is Practically
|
|
# No Limit In What Could Be Added To This Class. The First Things That Comes
|
|
# To My Mind Are:
|
|
#
|
|
# 1. Try To Implement A More Flicker-Free Background Image In Cases Like
|
|
# Centered Or Stretched Image (Now CustomTreeCtrl Supports Only Tiled
|
|
# Background Images).
|
|
#
|
|
# 2. Try To Mimic Windows wx.TreeCtrl Expanding/Collapsing behaviour: CustomTreeCtrl
|
|
# Suddenly Expands/Collapses The Nodes On Mouse Click While The Native Control
|
|
# Has Some Kind Of "Smooth" Expanding/Collapsing, Like A Wave. I Don't Even
|
|
# Know Where To Start To Do That.
|
|
#
|
|
# 3. Speed Up General OnPaint Things? I Have No Idea, Here CustomTreeCtrl Is Quite
|
|
# Fast, But We Should See On Slower Machines.
|
|
#
|
|
#
|
|
# For All Kind Of Problems, Requests Of Enhancements And Bug Reports, Please
|
|
# Write To Me At:
|
|
#
|
|
# andrea.gavana@maerskoil.com
|
|
# andrea.gavana@gmail.com
|
|
#
|
|
# Or, Obviously, To The wxPython Mailing List!!!
|
|
#
|
|
# Tags: phoenix-port, unittest, documented, py3-port
|
|
#
|
|
# End Of Comments
|
|
# --------------------------------------------------------------------------------- #
|
|
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is a class that mimics the behaviour of :class:`TreeCtrl`, with some more
|
|
enhancements.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
===========
|
|
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is a class that mimics the behaviour of :class:`TreeCtrl`, with almost the
|
|
same base functionalities plus some more enhancements. This class does not rely on
|
|
the native control, as it is a full owner-drawn tree control.
|
|
Apart of the base functionalities of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` (described below), in addition
|
|
to the standard :class:`TreeCtrl` behaviour this class supports:
|
|
|
|
* CheckBox-type items: checkboxes are easy to handle, just selected or unselected
|
|
state with no particular issues in handling the item's children;
|
|
* Added support for 3-state value checkbox items;
|
|
* RadioButton-type items: since I elected to put radiobuttons in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`, I
|
|
needed some way to handle them, that made sense. So, I used the following approach:
|
|
|
|
- All peer-nodes that are radiobuttons will be mutually exclusive. In other words,
|
|
only one of a set of radiobuttons that share a common parent can be checked at
|
|
once. If a radiobutton node becomes checked, then all of its peer radiobuttons
|
|
must be unchecked.
|
|
- If a radiobutton node becomes unchecked, then all of its child nodes will become
|
|
inactive.
|
|
|
|
* Hyperlink-type items: they look like an hyperlink, with the proper mouse cursor on
|
|
hovering;
|
|
* Multiline text items (**note**: to add a newline character in a multiline item, press
|
|
``Shift`` + ``Enter`` as the ``Enter`` key alone is consumed by :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` to finish
|
|
the editing and ``Ctrl`` + ``Enter`` is consumed by the platform for tab navigation);
|
|
* Enabling/disabling items (together with their plain or grayed out icons);
|
|
* Whatever non-toplevel widget can be attached next to an item;
|
|
* Possibility to horizontally align the widgets attached to tree items on the
|
|
same tree level.
|
|
* Possibility to align the widgets attached to tree items to the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`;
|
|
* Default selection style, gradient (horizontal/vertical) selection style and Windows
|
|
Vista selection style;
|
|
* Customized drag and drop images built on the fly;
|
|
* Setting the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` item buttons to a personalized imagelist;
|
|
* Setting the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` check/radio item icons to a personalized imagelist;
|
|
* Changing the style of the lines that connect the items (in terms of :class:`Pen` styles);
|
|
* Using an image as a :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` background (currently only in "tile" mode);
|
|
* Adding images to any item in the leftmost area of the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` client window.
|
|
* Separator-type items which are simply visual indicators that are meant to set apart
|
|
or divide tree items, with the following caveats:
|
|
|
|
- Separator items should not have children, labels, data or an associated window;
|
|
- You can change the color of individual separators by using :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemTextColour`, or you can use
|
|
:meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetSeparatorColour` to change the color of all separators. The default separator colour
|
|
is that returned by `SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_GRAYTEXT)`;
|
|
- Separators can be selected just like any other tree item;
|
|
- Separators cannot have text;
|
|
- Separators cannot have children;
|
|
- Separators cannot be edited via the ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` event.
|
|
|
|
* Ellipsization of long items when the horizontal space is low, via the ``TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS``
|
|
style (`New in version 0.9.3`);
|
|
* Tooltips on long items when the horizontal space is low, via the ``TR_TOOLTIP_ON_LONG_ITEMS``
|
|
style (`New in version 0.9.3`).
|
|
|
|
And a lot more. Check the demo for an almost complete review of the functionalities.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Base Functionalities
|
|
====================
|
|
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` supports all the :class:`TreeCtrl` styles, except:
|
|
|
|
- ``TR_EXTENDED``: supports for this style is on the todo list (am I sure of this?).
|
|
|
|
Plus it has 3 more styles to handle checkbox-type items:
|
|
|
|
- ``TR_AUTO_CHECK_CHILD``: automatically checks/unchecks the item children;
|
|
- ``TR_AUTO_CHECK_PARENT``: automatically checks/unchecks the item parent;
|
|
- ``TR_AUTO_TOGGLE_CHILD``: automatically toggles the item children.
|
|
|
|
And two styles you can use to force the horizontal alignment of all the widgets
|
|
attached to the tree items:
|
|
|
|
- ``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS``: aligns horizontally the windows belonging to the item on the
|
|
same tree level.
|
|
- ``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT``: aligns to the rightmost position the windows belonging
|
|
to the item on the same tree level.
|
|
|
|
And two styles related to long items (with a lot of text in them), which can be
|
|
ellipsized and/or highlighted with a tooltip:
|
|
|
|
- ``TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS``: ellipsizes long items when the horizontal space for
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low (`New in version 0.9.3`);
|
|
- ``TR_TOOLTIP_ON_LONG_ITEMS``: shows tooltips on long items when the horizontal space
|
|
for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low (`New in version 0.9.3`);.
|
|
|
|
All the methods available in :class:`TreeCtrl` are also available in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Usage
|
|
=====
|
|
|
|
Usage example::
|
|
|
|
import wx
|
|
import wx.lib.agw.customtreectrl as CT
|
|
|
|
class MyFrame(wx.Frame):
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, parent):
|
|
|
|
wx.Frame.__init__(self, parent, -1, "CustomTreeCtrl Demo")
|
|
|
|
# Create a CustomTreeCtrl instance
|
|
custom_tree = CT.CustomTreeCtrl(self, agwStyle=wx.TR_DEFAULT_STYLE)
|
|
|
|
# Add a root node to it
|
|
root = custom_tree.AddRoot("The Root Item")
|
|
|
|
# Create an image list to add icons next to an item
|
|
il = wx.ImageList(16, 16)
|
|
fldridx = il.Add(wx.ArtProvider.GetBitmap(wx.ART_FOLDER, wx.ART_OTHER, (16, 16)))
|
|
fldropenidx = il.Add(wx.ArtProvider.GetBitmap(wx.ART_FILE_OPEN, wx.ART_OTHER, (16, 16)))
|
|
fileidx = il.Add(wx.ArtProvider.GetBitmap(wx.ART_NORMAL_FILE, wx.ART_OTHER, (16, 16)))
|
|
|
|
custom_tree.SetImageList(il)
|
|
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(root, fldridx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(root, fldropenidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Expanded)
|
|
|
|
for x in range(15):
|
|
child = custom_tree.AppendItem(root, "Item %d" % x)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(child, fldridx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(child, fldropenidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Expanded)
|
|
|
|
for y in range(5):
|
|
last = custom_tree.AppendItem(child, "item %d-%s" % (x, chr(ord("a")+y)))
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(last, fldridx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(last, fldropenidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Expanded)
|
|
|
|
for z in range(5):
|
|
item = custom_tree.AppendItem(last, "item %d-%s-%d" % (x, chr(ord("a")+y), z))
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(item, fileidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
|
|
custom_tree.Expand(root)
|
|
|
|
|
|
# our normal wxApp-derived class, as usual
|
|
|
|
app = wx.App(0)
|
|
|
|
frame = MyFrame(None)
|
|
app.SetTopWindow(frame)
|
|
frame.Show()
|
|
|
|
app.MainLoop()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Events
|
|
======
|
|
|
|
All the events supported by :class:`TreeCtrl` are also available in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`, with
|
|
a few exceptions:
|
|
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_GET_INFO`` (don't know what this means);
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_SET_INFO`` (don't know what this means);
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_MIDDLE_CLICK`` (not implemented, but easy to add);
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_STATE_IMAGE_CLICK`` (no need for that, look at the checking events below).
|
|
|
|
Plus, :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` supports the events related to the checkbutton-type items:
|
|
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING``: an item is being checked;
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED``: an item has been checked.
|
|
|
|
And to hyperlink-type items:
|
|
|
|
- ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK``: an hyperlink item has been clicked (this event is sent
|
|
after the ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` event).
|
|
|
|
|
|
Supported Platforms
|
|
===================
|
|
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has been tested on the following platforms:
|
|
* Windows (Windows XP);
|
|
* GTK (Thanks to Michele Petrazzo);
|
|
* Mac OS (Thanks to John Jackson).
|
|
|
|
|
|
Window Styles
|
|
=============
|
|
|
|
This class supports the following window styles:
|
|
|
|
============================== =========== ==================================================
|
|
Window Styles Hex Value Description
|
|
============================== =========== ==================================================
|
|
``TR_NO_BUTTONS`` 0x0 For convenience to document that no buttons are to be drawn.
|
|
``TR_SINGLE`` 0x0 For convenience to document that only one item may be selected at a time. Selecting another item causes the current selection, if any, to be deselected. This is the default.
|
|
``TR_HAS_BUTTONS`` 0x1 Use this style to show + and - buttons to the left of parent items.
|
|
``TR_NO_LINES`` 0x4 Use this style to hide vertical level connectors.
|
|
``TR_LINES_AT_ROOT`` 0x8 Use this style to show lines between root nodes. Only applicable if ``TR_HIDE_ROOT`` is set and ``TR_NO_LINES`` is not set.
|
|
``TR_DEFAULT_STYLE`` 0x9 The set of flags that are closest to the defaults for the native control for a particular toolkit.
|
|
``TR_TWIST_BUTTONS`` 0x10 Use old Mac-twist style buttons.
|
|
``TR_MULTIPLE`` 0x20 Use this style to allow a range of items to be selected. If a second range is selected, the current range, if any, is deselected.
|
|
``TR_EXTENDED`` 0x40 Use this style to allow disjoint items to be selected. (Only partially implemented; may not work in all cases).
|
|
``TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT`` 0x80 Use this style to cause row heights to be just big enough to fit the content. If not set, all rows use the largest row height. The default is that this flag is unset.
|
|
``TR_EDIT_LABELS`` 0x200 Use this style if you wish the user to be able to edit labels in the tree control.
|
|
``TR_ROW_LINES`` 0x400 Use this style to draw a contrasting border between displayed rows.
|
|
``TR_HIDE_ROOT`` 0x800 Use this style to suppress the display of the root node, effectively causing the first-level nodes to appear as a series of root nodes.
|
|
``TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT`` 0x2000 Use this style to have the background colour and the selection highlight extend over the entire horizontal row of the tree control window.
|
|
``TR_AUTO_CHECK_CHILD`` 0x4000 Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a parent item is checked/unchecked its children are checked/unchecked as well.
|
|
``TR_AUTO_TOGGLE_CHILD`` 0x8000 Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a parent item is checked/unchecked its children are toggled accordingly.
|
|
``TR_AUTO_CHECK_PARENT`` 0x10000 Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a child item is checked/unchecked its parent item is checked/unchecked as well.
|
|
``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS`` 0x20000 Flag used to align windows (in items with windows) at the same horizontal position.
|
|
``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT`` 0x40000 Flag used to align windows (in items with windows) to the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
``TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS`` 0x80000 Flag used to ellipsize long items when the horizontal space for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low.
|
|
``TR_TOOLTIP_ON_LONG_ITEMS`` 0x100000 Flag used to show tooltips on long items when the horizontal space for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low.
|
|
============================== =========== ==================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
Events Processing
|
|
=================
|
|
|
|
This class processes the following events:
|
|
|
|
============================== ==================================================
|
|
Event Name Description
|
|
============================== ==================================================
|
|
``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG`` Begin dragging with the left mouse button.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` Begin editing a label. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG`` Begin dragging with the right mouse button.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM`` Delete an item.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_DRAG`` End dragging with the left or right mouse button.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` End editing a label. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_GET_INFO`` Request information from the application (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED`` The item has been activated, i.e. chosen by double clicking it with mouse or from keyboard.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED`` A checkbox or radiobox type item has been checked.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING`` A checkbox or radiobox type item is being checked.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED`` The item has been collapsed.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING`` The item is being collapsed. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED`` The item has been expanded.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING`` The item is being expanded. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP`` The opportunity to set the item tooltip is being given to the application (call `TreeEvent.SetToolTip`).
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK`` An hyperlink type item has been clicked.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_MENU`` The context menu for the selected item has been requested, either by a right click or by using the menu key.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_MIDDLE_CLICK`` The user has clicked the item with the middle mouse button (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_RIGHT_CLICK`` The user has clicked the item with the right mouse button.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN`` A key has been pressed.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` Selection has changed.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING`` Selection is changing. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`.
|
|
``EVT_TREE_SET_INFO`` Information is being supplied to the application (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
``EVT_TREE_STATE_IMAGE_CLICK`` The state image has been clicked (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
============================== ==================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
License And Version
|
|
===================
|
|
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is distributed under the wxPython license.
|
|
|
|
Latest Revision: Andrea Gavana @ 09 Jan 2014, 23.00 GMT
|
|
|
|
Version 2.6
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Version Info
|
|
__version__ = "2.6"
|
|
|
|
import wx
|
|
from wx.lib.expando import ExpandoTextCtrl
|
|
|
|
# Python 2/3 compatibility helper
|
|
import wx.lib.six as six
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# Constants
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
_NO_IMAGE = -1
|
|
_PIXELS_PER_UNIT = 10
|
|
|
|
# Start editing the current item after half a second (if the mouse hasn't
|
|
# been clicked/moved)
|
|
_DELAY = 500
|
|
|
|
# wxPython version string
|
|
_VERSION_STRING = wx.VERSION_STRING
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# Constants
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
# Enum for different images associated with a treectrl item
|
|
TreeItemIcon_Normal = 0 # not selected, not expanded
|
|
""" The tree item is not selected and not expanded. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_Selected = 1 # selected, not expanded
|
|
""" The tree item is selected and not expanded. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_Expanded = 2 # not selected, expanded
|
|
""" The tree item is not selected but expanded. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_SelectedExpanded = 3 # selected, expanded
|
|
""" The tree item is selected and expanded. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_Checked = 0 # check button, checked
|
|
""" The item's check button is checked. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_NotChecked = 1 # check button, not checked
|
|
""" The item's check button is not checked. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_Undetermined = 2 # check button, undetermined
|
|
""" The item's check button is in undetermined state (used only for a 3-state check button). """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_Flagged = 3 # radio button, selected
|
|
""" The item's radio button is checked. """
|
|
TreeItemIcon_NotFlagged = 4 # radio button, not selected
|
|
""" The item's radio button is not checked. """
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# CustomTreeCtrl flags
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
TR_NO_BUTTONS = wx.TR_NO_BUTTONS # for convenience
|
|
""" For convenience to document that no buttons are to be drawn. """
|
|
TR_HAS_BUTTONS = wx.TR_HAS_BUTTONS # draw collapsed/expanded btns
|
|
""" Use this style to show + and - buttons to the left of parent items. """
|
|
TR_NO_LINES = wx.TR_NO_LINES # don't draw lines at all
|
|
""" Use this style to hide vertical level connectors. """
|
|
TR_LINES_AT_ROOT = wx.TR_LINES_AT_ROOT # connect top-level nodes
|
|
""" Use this style to show lines between root nodes. Only applicable if ``TR_HIDE_ROOT`` is set and ``TR_NO_LINES`` is not set. """
|
|
TR_TWIST_BUTTONS = wx.TR_TWIST_BUTTONS # still used by wxTreeListCtrl
|
|
""" Use old Mac-twist style buttons. """
|
|
TR_SINGLE = wx.TR_SINGLE # for convenience
|
|
""" For convenience to document that only one item may be selected at a time. Selecting another item causes the current selection, if any, to be deselected. This is the default. """
|
|
TR_MULTIPLE = wx.TR_MULTIPLE # can select multiple items
|
|
""" Use this style to allow a range of items to be selected. If a second range is selected, the current range, if any, is deselected. """
|
|
TR_EXTENDED = 0x40 # TODO: allow extended selection
|
|
""" Use this style to allow disjoint items to be selected. (Only partially implemented; may not work in all cases). """
|
|
TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT = wx.TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT # what it says
|
|
""" Use this style to cause row heights to be just big enough to fit the content. If not set, all rows use the largest row height. The default is that this flag is unset. """
|
|
TR_EDIT_LABELS = wx.TR_EDIT_LABELS # can edit item labels
|
|
""" Use this style if you wish the user to be able to edit labels in the tree control. """
|
|
TR_ROW_LINES = wx.TR_ROW_LINES # put border around items
|
|
""" Use this style to draw a contrasting border between displayed rows. """
|
|
TR_HIDE_ROOT = wx.TR_HIDE_ROOT # don't display root node
|
|
""" Use this style to suppress the display of the root node, effectively causing the first-level nodes to appear as a series of root nodes. """
|
|
TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT = wx.TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT # highlight full horz space
|
|
""" Use this style to have the background colour and the selection highlight extend over the entire horizontal row of the tree control window. """
|
|
|
|
TR_AUTO_CHECK_CHILD = 0x04000 # only meaningful for checkboxes
|
|
""" Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a parent item is checked/unchecked its children are checked/unchecked as well. """
|
|
TR_AUTO_TOGGLE_CHILD = 0x08000 # only meaningful for checkboxes
|
|
""" Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a parent item is checked/unchecked its children are toggled accordingly. """
|
|
TR_AUTO_CHECK_PARENT = 0x10000 # only meaningful for checkboxes
|
|
""" Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a child item is checked/unchecked its parent item is checked/unchecked as well. """
|
|
TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS = 0x20000 # to align windows horizontally for items at the same level
|
|
""" Flag used to align windows (in items with windows) at the same horizontal position. """
|
|
TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT = 0x40000 # to align windows to the rightmost edge of CustomTreeCtrl
|
|
""" Flag used to align windows (in items with windows) to the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`."""
|
|
TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS = 0x80000 # to ellipsize long items when horizontal space is low
|
|
""" Flag used to ellipsize long items when the horizontal space for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low."""
|
|
TR_TOOLTIP_ON_LONG_ITEMS = 0x100000 # to display tooltips on long items when horizontal space is low
|
|
""" Flag used to show tooltips on long items when the horizontal space for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low."""
|
|
|
|
TR_DEFAULT_STYLE = wx.TR_DEFAULT_STYLE # default style for the tree control
|
|
""" The set of flags that are closest to the defaults for the native control for a particular toolkit. """
|
|
|
|
# Values for the `flags` parameter of CustomTreeCtrl.HitTest() which determine
|
|
# where exactly the specified point is situated:
|
|
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ABOVE = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ABOVE
|
|
""" Above the client area. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_BELOW = wx.TREE_HITTEST_BELOW
|
|
""" Below the client area. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_NOWHERE = wx.TREE_HITTEST_NOWHERE
|
|
""" No item has been hit. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMBUTTON = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMBUTTON
|
|
""" On the button associated with an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMICON = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMICON
|
|
""" On the bitmap associated with an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMINDENT = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMINDENT
|
|
""" On the indent associated with an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL
|
|
""" On the label (string) associated with an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMRIGHT = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMRIGHT
|
|
""" On the right of the label associated with an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMSTATEICON = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMSTATEICON
|
|
""" On the right of the label associated with an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_TOLEFT = wx.TREE_HITTEST_TOLEFT
|
|
""" On the left of an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_TORIGHT = wx.TREE_HITTEST_TORIGHT
|
|
""" On the right of an item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMUPPERPART = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMUPPERPART
|
|
""" On the upper part (first half) of the item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLOWERPART = wx.TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLOWERPART
|
|
""" On the lower part (second half) of the item. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMCHECKICON = 0x4000
|
|
""" On the check icon, if present. """
|
|
TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM = TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMICON | TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL | TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMCHECKICON
|
|
""" Anywhere on the item. """
|
|
|
|
TREE_ITEMTYPE_NORMAL = 0
|
|
""" A normal item. """
|
|
TREE_ITEMTYPE_CHECK = 1
|
|
""" A checkbox-like item. """
|
|
TREE_ITEMTYPE_RADIO = 2
|
|
""" A radiobutton-like item. """
|
|
|
|
# Background Image Style
|
|
_StyleTile = 0
|
|
_StyleStretch = 1
|
|
|
|
# Windows Vista Colours
|
|
_rgbSelectOuter = wx.Colour(170, 200, 245)
|
|
_rgbSelectInner = wx.Colour(230, 250, 250)
|
|
_rgbSelectTop = wx.Colour(210, 240, 250)
|
|
_rgbSelectBottom = wx.Colour(185, 215, 250)
|
|
_rgbNoFocusTop = wx.Colour(250, 250, 250)
|
|
_rgbNoFocusBottom = wx.Colour(235, 235, 235)
|
|
_rgbNoFocusOuter = wx.Colour(220, 220, 220)
|
|
_rgbNoFocusInner = wx.Colour(245, 245, 245)
|
|
|
|
# Flags for wx.RendererNative
|
|
_CONTROL_EXPANDED = 8
|
|
_CONTROL_CURRENT = 16
|
|
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# CustomTreeCtrl events and binding for handling them
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_DELETE_ITEM
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_GET_INFO = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_GET_INFO
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_SET_INFO = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_SET_INFO
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_SEL_CHANGED
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_SEL_CHANGING
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_KEY_DOWN
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_RIGHT_CLICK = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_RIGHT_CLICK
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_MIDDLE_CLICK = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_MIDDLE_CLICK
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_END_DRAG = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_END_DRAG
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_STATE_IMAGE_CLICK = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_STATE_IMAGE_CLICK
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_MENU = wx.wxEVT_COMMAND_TREE_ITEM_MENU
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING = wx.NewEventType()
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED = wx.NewEventType()
|
|
wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK = wx.NewEventType()
|
|
|
|
EVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG = wx.EVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG
|
|
""" Begin dragging with the left mouse button. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG = wx.EVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG
|
|
""" Begin dragging with the right mouse button. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT = wx.EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT
|
|
""" Begin editing a label. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT = wx.EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT
|
|
""" End editing a label. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM = wx.EVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM
|
|
""" Delete an item. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_GET_INFO = wx.EVT_TREE_GET_INFO
|
|
""" Request information from the application (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`). """
|
|
EVT_TREE_SET_INFO = wx.EVT_TREE_SET_INFO
|
|
""" Information is being supplied to the application (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`). """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED
|
|
""" The item has been expanded. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING
|
|
""" The item is being expanded. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED
|
|
""" The item has been collapsed. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING
|
|
""" The item is being collapsed. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED = wx.EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED
|
|
""" Selection has changed. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING = wx.EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING
|
|
""" Selection is changing. This can be prevented by calling :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN = wx.EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN
|
|
""" A key has been pressed. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED
|
|
""" The item has been activated, i.e. chosen by double clicking it with mouse or from keyboard. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_RIGHT_CLICK = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_RIGHT_CLICK
|
|
""" The user has clicked the item with the right mouse button. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_MIDDLE_CLICK = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_MIDDLE_CLICK
|
|
""" The user has clicked the item with the middle mouse button (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`). """
|
|
EVT_TREE_END_DRAG = wx.EVT_TREE_END_DRAG
|
|
""" End dragging with the left or right mouse button. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_STATE_IMAGE_CLICK = wx.EVT_TREE_STATE_IMAGE_CLICK
|
|
""" The state image has been clicked (not implemented in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`). """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP
|
|
""" The opportunity to set the item tooltip is being given to the application (call `TreeEvent.SetToolTip`). """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_MENU = wx.EVT_TREE_ITEM_MENU
|
|
""" The context menu for the selected item has been requested, either by a right click or by using the menu key. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING = wx.PyEventBinder(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING, 1)
|
|
""" A checkbox or radiobox type item is being checked. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED = wx.PyEventBinder(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED, 1)
|
|
""" A checkbox or radiobox type item has been checked. """
|
|
EVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK = wx.PyEventBinder(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK, 1)
|
|
""" An hyperlink type item has been clicked. """
|
|
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def MakeDisabledBitmap(original):
|
|
"""
|
|
Creates a disabled-looking bitmap starting from the input one.
|
|
|
|
:param `original`: an instance of :class:`Bitmap` to be greyed-out.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Bitmap`, containing a disabled-looking
|
|
representation of the original item image.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
img = original.ConvertToImage()
|
|
return wx.Bitmap(img.ConvertToGreyscale())
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def DrawTreeItemButton(win, dc, rect, flags):
|
|
"""
|
|
Draw the expanded/collapsed icon for a tree control item.
|
|
|
|
:param `win`: an instance of :class:`Window`;
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param Rect `rect`: the client rectangle where to draw the tree item button;
|
|
:param integer `flags`: contains ``wx.CONTROL_EXPANDED`` bit for expanded tree items.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is a simple replacement of :meth:`RendererNative.DrawTreeItemButton`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is never used in wxPython versions newer than 2.6.2.1.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# white background
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.GREY_PEN)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.WHITE_BRUSH)
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(rect)
|
|
|
|
# black lines
|
|
xMiddle = rect.x + rect.width//2
|
|
yMiddle = rect.y + rect.height//2
|
|
|
|
# half of the length of the horz lines in "-" and "+"
|
|
halfWidth = rect.width//2 - 2
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.BLACK_PEN)
|
|
dc.DrawLine(xMiddle - halfWidth, yMiddle,
|
|
xMiddle + halfWidth + 1, yMiddle)
|
|
|
|
if not flags & _CONTROL_EXPANDED:
|
|
|
|
# turn "-" into "+"
|
|
halfHeight = rect.height//2 - 2
|
|
dc.DrawLine(xMiddle, yMiddle - halfHeight,
|
|
xMiddle, yMiddle + halfHeight + 1)
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def EventFlagsToSelType(style, shiftDown=False, ctrlDown=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Translate the key or mouse event flag to the type of selection we
|
|
are dealing with.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `style`: the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` window style flag;
|
|
:param bool `shiftDown`: ``True`` if the ``Shift`` key is pressed, ``False`` otherwise;
|
|
:param bool `ctrlDown`: ``True`` if the ``Ctrl`` key is pressed, ``False`` otherwise;
|
|
|
|
:return: A 3-elements tuple, with the following elements:
|
|
|
|
- `is_multiple`: ``True`` if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_MULTIPLE`` flag set, ``False`` otherwise;
|
|
- `extended_select`: ``True`` if the ``Shift`` key is pressend and if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the
|
|
``TR_MULTIPLE`` flag set, ``False`` otherwise;
|
|
- `unselect_others`: ``True`` if the ``Ctrl`` key is pressend and if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the
|
|
``TR_MULTIPLE`` flag set, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
is_multiple = (style & TR_MULTIPLE) != 0
|
|
extended_select = shiftDown and is_multiple
|
|
unselect_others = not (extended_select or (ctrlDown and is_multiple))
|
|
|
|
return is_multiple, extended_select, unselect_others
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def ChopText(dc, text, max_size):
|
|
"""
|
|
Chops the input `text` if its size does not fit in `max_size`, by cutting the
|
|
text and adding ellipsis at the end.
|
|
|
|
:param `dc`: a :class:`DC` device context;
|
|
:param `text`: the text to chop;
|
|
:param `max_size`: the maximum size in which the text should fit.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is used exclusively when :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS``
|
|
style set.
|
|
|
|
.. versionadded:: 0.9.3
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# first check if the text fits with no problems
|
|
x, y, dummy = dc.GetFullMultiLineTextExtent(text)
|
|
|
|
if x <= max_size:
|
|
return text
|
|
|
|
textLen = len(text)
|
|
last_good_length = 0
|
|
|
|
for i in range(textLen, -1, -1):
|
|
s = text[0:i]
|
|
s += "..."
|
|
|
|
x, y = dc.GetTextExtent(s)
|
|
last_good_length = i
|
|
|
|
if x < max_size:
|
|
break
|
|
|
|
ret = text[0:last_good_length] + "..."
|
|
return ret
|
|
|
|
|
|
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# DragImage Implementation
|
|
# This Class Handles The Creation Of A Custom Image In Case Of Item Drag
|
|
# And Drop.
|
|
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class DragImage(wx.DragImage):
|
|
"""
|
|
This class handles the creation of a custom image in case of item drag
|
|
and drop.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, treeCtrl, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param `treeCtrl`: the parent :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`;
|
|
:param `item`: one of the tree control item (an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
text = item.GetText()
|
|
font = item.Attr().GetFont()
|
|
colour = item.Attr().GetTextColour()
|
|
if not colour:
|
|
colour = wx.BLACK
|
|
if not font:
|
|
font = treeCtrl._normalFont
|
|
|
|
backcolour = treeCtrl.GetBackgroundColour()
|
|
r, g, b = int(backcolour.Red()), int(backcolour.Green()), int(backcolour.Blue())
|
|
backcolour = ((r >> 1) + 20, (g >> 1) + 20, (b >> 1) + 20)
|
|
backcolour = wx.Colour(backcolour[0], backcolour[1], backcolour[2])
|
|
self._backgroundColour = backcolour
|
|
|
|
tempdc = wx.ClientDC(treeCtrl)
|
|
tempdc.SetFont(font)
|
|
width, height, dummy = tempdc.GetFullMultiLineTextExtent(text + "M")
|
|
|
|
image = item.GetCurrentImage()
|
|
|
|
image_w, image_h = 0, 0
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = 0, 0
|
|
itemcheck = None
|
|
itemimage = None
|
|
ximagepos = 0
|
|
yimagepos = 0
|
|
xcheckpos = 0
|
|
ycheckpos = 0
|
|
|
|
if image != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
if treeCtrl._imageListNormal:
|
|
image_w, image_h = treeCtrl._imageListNormal.GetSize(image)
|
|
image_w += 4
|
|
itemimage = treeCtrl._imageListNormal.GetBitmap(image)
|
|
|
|
checkimage = item.GetCurrentCheckedImage()
|
|
|
|
if checkimage is not None:
|
|
if treeCtrl._imageListCheck:
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = treeCtrl._imageListCheck.GetSize(checkimage)
|
|
wcheck += 4
|
|
itemcheck = treeCtrl._imageListCheck.GetBitmap(checkimage)
|
|
|
|
total_h = max(hcheck, height)
|
|
total_h = max(image_h, total_h)
|
|
|
|
if image_w:
|
|
ximagepos = wcheck
|
|
yimagepos = ((total_h > image_h) and [(total_h-image_h)//2] or [0])[0]
|
|
|
|
if checkimage is not None:
|
|
xcheckpos = 2
|
|
ycheckpos = ((total_h > image_h) and [(total_h-image_h)//2] or [0])[0] + 2
|
|
|
|
extraH = ((total_h > height) and [(total_h - height)//2] or [0])[0]
|
|
|
|
xtextpos = wcheck + image_w
|
|
ytextpos = extraH
|
|
|
|
total_h = max(image_h, hcheck)
|
|
total_h = max(total_h, height)
|
|
|
|
if total_h < 30:
|
|
total_h += 2 # at least 2 pixels
|
|
else:
|
|
total_h += total_h//10 # otherwise 10% extra spacing
|
|
|
|
total_w = image_w + wcheck + width
|
|
|
|
self._total_w = total_w
|
|
self._total_h = total_h
|
|
self._itemimage = itemimage
|
|
self._itemcheck = itemcheck
|
|
self._text = text
|
|
self._colour = colour
|
|
self._font = font
|
|
self._xtextpos = xtextpos
|
|
self._ytextpos = ytextpos
|
|
self._ximagepos = ximagepos
|
|
self._yimagepos = yimagepos
|
|
self._xcheckpos = xcheckpos
|
|
self._ycheckpos = ycheckpos
|
|
self._textwidth = width
|
|
self._textheight = height
|
|
self._extraH = extraH
|
|
|
|
self._bitmap = self.CreateBitmap()
|
|
|
|
wx.DragImage.__init__(self, self._bitmap)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CreateBitmap(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Actually creates the drag and drop bitmap for :class:`DragImage`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`DragImage`, a close representation of the item's
|
|
appearance (i.e., a screenshot of the item).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
memory = wx.MemoryDC()
|
|
|
|
bitmap = wx.Bitmap(self._total_w, self._total_h)
|
|
memory.SelectObject(bitmap)
|
|
|
|
if wx.Platform == '__WXMAC__':
|
|
memory.SetBackground(wx.TRANSPARENT_BRUSH)
|
|
else:
|
|
memory.SetBackground(wx.Brush(self._backgroundColour))
|
|
memory.SetBackgroundMode(wx.TRANSPARENT)
|
|
memory.SetFont(self._font)
|
|
memory.SetTextForeground(self._colour)
|
|
memory.Clear()
|
|
|
|
if self._itemimage:
|
|
memory.DrawBitmap(self._itemimage, self._ximagepos, self._yimagepos, True)
|
|
|
|
if self._itemcheck:
|
|
memory.DrawBitmap(self._itemcheck, self._xcheckpos, self._ycheckpos, True)
|
|
|
|
textrect = wx.Rect(self._xtextpos, self._ytextpos+self._extraH, self._textwidth, self._textheight)
|
|
memory.DrawLabel(self._text, textrect)
|
|
|
|
memory.SelectObject(wx.NullBitmap)
|
|
|
|
# Gtk and Windows unfortunatly don't do so well with transparent
|
|
# drawing so this hack corrects the image to have a transparent
|
|
# background.
|
|
if wx.Platform != '__WXMAC__':
|
|
timg = bitmap.ConvertToImage()
|
|
if not timg.HasAlpha():
|
|
timg.InitAlpha()
|
|
for y in range(timg.GetHeight()):
|
|
for x in range(timg.GetWidth()):
|
|
pix = wx.Colour(timg.GetRed(x, y),
|
|
timg.GetGreen(x, y),
|
|
timg.GetBlue(x, y))
|
|
if pix == self._backgroundColour:
|
|
timg.SetAlpha(x, y, 0)
|
|
bitmap = timg.ConvertToBitmap()
|
|
return bitmap
|
|
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# TreeItemAttr: a structure containing the visual attributes of an item
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class TreeItemAttr(object):
|
|
"""
|
|
Creates the item attributes (text colour, background colour and font).
|
|
|
|
:note: This class is inspired by the wxWidgets generic implementation of :class:`TreeItemAttr`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, colText=wx.NullColour, colBack=wx.NullColour, colBorder=wx.NullColour,font=wx.NullFont):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param `colText`: the text colour, an instance of :class:`Colour`;
|
|
:param `colBack`: the tree item background colour, an instance of :class:`Colour`;
|
|
:param `colBorder`: the tree item border colour, an instance of :class:`Colour`;
|
|
:param `font`: the tree item font, an instance of :class:`Font`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._colText = colText
|
|
self._colBack = colBack
|
|
self._colBorder = colBorder
|
|
self._font = font
|
|
|
|
# setters
|
|
def SetTextColour(self, colText):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the text colour attribute.
|
|
|
|
:param `colText`: an instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._colText = colText
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetBackgroundColour(self, colBack):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item background colour attribute.
|
|
|
|
:param `colBack`: an instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._colBack = colBack
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetBorderColour(self, colBorder):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item border colour attribute.
|
|
|
|
:param `colBack`: an instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
|
|
.. versionadded:: 0.9.6
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._colBorder = colBorder
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetFont(self, font):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item font attribute.
|
|
|
|
:param `font`: an instance of :class:`Font`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._font = font
|
|
|
|
|
|
# accessors
|
|
def HasTextColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the attribute has text colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the text colour attribute has been set, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._colText != wx.NullColour and self._colText.IsOk()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasBackgroundColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the attribute has background colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the background colour attribute has been set, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._colBack != wx.NullColour and self._colBack.IsOk()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasBorderColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the attribute has border colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the border colour attribute has been set, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
.. versionadded:: 0.9.6
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._colBorder != wx.NullColour and self._colBorder.IsOk()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasFont(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the attribute has font.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the font attribute has been set, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._font != wx.NullFont and self._font.IsOk()
|
|
|
|
|
|
# getters
|
|
def GetTextColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the attribute text colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._colText
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetBackgroundColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the attribute background colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._colBack
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetBorderColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the attribute border colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
|
|
.. versionadded:: 0.9.6
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._colBorder
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetFont(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the attribute font.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Font`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._font
|
|
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# CommandTreeEvent Is A Special Subclassing Of wx.CommandEvent
|
|
#
|
|
# NB: Note That Not All The Accessors Make Sense For All The Events, See The
|
|
# Event Description Below.
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class CommandTreeEvent(wx.CommandEvent):
|
|
"""
|
|
:class:`CommandTreeEvent` is a special subclassing of :class:`CommandEvent`.
|
|
|
|
:note: Not all the accessors make sense for all the events, see the event description for every method in this class.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, evtType, evtId, item=None, evtKey=None, point=None,
|
|
label=None, **kwargs):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param integer `evtType`: the event type;
|
|
:param integer `evtId`: the event identifier;
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `evtKey`: a character ordinal;
|
|
:param `point`: an instance of :class:`Point`;
|
|
:param string `label`: a :class:`GenericTreeItem` text label.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
wx.CommandEvent.__init__(self, evtType, evtId, **kwargs)
|
|
self._item = item
|
|
self._evtKey = evtKey
|
|
self._pointDrag = point
|
|
self._label = label
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItem(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gets the item on which the operation was performed or the newly selected
|
|
item for ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` and ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING`` events.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._item
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItem(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item on which the operation was performed or the newly selected
|
|
item for ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` and ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING`` events.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._item = item
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetOldItem(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the previously selected item for ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING`` events.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._itemOld
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetOldItem(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the previously selected item for ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING`` events.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._itemOld = item
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetPoint(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the point where the mouse was when the drag operation started
|
|
(for ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG`` and ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG`` events only)
|
|
or the click position.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Point`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._pointDrag
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetPoint(self, pt):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the point where the mouse was when the drag operation started
|
|
(for ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG`` and ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG`` events only)
|
|
or the click position.
|
|
|
|
:param `pt`: an instance of :class:`Point`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._pointDrag = pt
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetKeyEvent(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the keyboard data (for ``EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN`` event only).
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`KeyEvent`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._evtKey
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetKeyCode(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the virtual key code. ASCII events return normal ASCII values, while
|
|
non-ASCII events return values such as ``wx.WXK_LEFT`` for the left cursor key.
|
|
|
|
This method is for ``EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN`` events only.
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer representing the virtual key code.
|
|
|
|
:note: In Unicode build, the returned value is meaningful only if the user entered
|
|
a character that can be represented in current locale's default charset. You can
|
|
obtain the corresponding Unicode character using `GetUnicodeKey`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._evtKey.GetKeyCode()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetKeyEvent(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the keyboard data (for ``EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN`` event only).
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`CommandTreeEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._evtKey = event
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetLabel(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item text (for ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` events only).
|
|
|
|
:return: A string containing the item text.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._label
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetLabel(self, label):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item text (for ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` events only).
|
|
|
|
:param string `label`: a string containing the new item text.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._label = label
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsEditCancelled(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the edit cancel flag (for ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` events only).
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` is the item editing has been cancelled, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._editCancelled
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetEditCanceled(self, editCancelled):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the edit cancel flag (for ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` events only).
|
|
|
|
:param bool `editCancelled`: ``True`` to cancel the editing, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._editCancelled = editCancelled
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetToolTip(self, toolTip):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the tooltip for the item (for ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP`` events).
|
|
|
|
:param string `tooltip`: a string representing the item tooltip.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._label = toolTip
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetToolTip(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the tooltip for the item (for ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP`` events).
|
|
|
|
:return: A string containing the item tooltip.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._label
|
|
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# TreeEvent is a special class for all events associated with tree controls
|
|
#
|
|
# NB: note that not all accessors make sense for all events, see the event
|
|
# descriptions below
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class TreeEvent(CommandTreeEvent):
|
|
"""
|
|
:class:`CommandTreeEvent` is a special class for all events associated with tree controls.
|
|
|
|
:note: Not all accessors make sense for all events, see the event descriptions below.
|
|
"""
|
|
def __init__(self, evtType, evtId, item=None, evtKey=None, point=None,
|
|
label=None, **kwargs):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param integer `evtType`: the event type;
|
|
:param integer `evtId`: the event identifier;
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `evtKey`: a character ordinal;
|
|
:param `point`: an instance of :class:`Point`;
|
|
:param string `label`: a :class:`GenericTreeItem` text label.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
CommandTreeEvent.__init__(self, evtType, evtId, item, evtKey, point, label, **kwargs)
|
|
self.notify = wx.NotifyEvent(evtType, evtId)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNotifyEvent(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the actual :class:`NotifyEvent`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`NotifyEvent`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.notify
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsAllowed(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns ``True`` if the change is allowed (:meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto` hasn't been called) or
|
|
``False`` otherwise (if it was).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.notify.IsAllowed()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Veto(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Prevents the change announced by this event from happening.
|
|
|
|
:note: It is in general a good idea to notify the user about the reasons
|
|
for vetoing the change because otherwise the applications behaviour (which
|
|
just refuses to do what the user wants) might be quite surprising.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.notify.Veto()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Allow(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
This is the opposite of :meth:`~TreeEvent.Veto`: it explicitly allows the event to be processed.
|
|
For most events it is not necessary to call this method as the events are
|
|
allowed anyhow but some are forbidden by default (this will be mentioned
|
|
in the corresponding event description).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.notify.Allow()
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# Auxiliary Classes: TreeEditTimer
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class TreeEditTimer(wx.Timer):
|
|
""" Timer used for enabling in-place edit."""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, owner):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param `owner`: the :class:`Timer` owner (an instance of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
wx.Timer.__init__(self)
|
|
self._owner = owner
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Notify(self):
|
|
""" The timer has expired, starts the item editing. """
|
|
|
|
self._owner.OnEditTimer()
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# Auxiliary Classes: TreeTextCtrl
|
|
# This Is The Temporary ExpandoTextCtrl Created When You Edit The Text Of An Item
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class TreeTextCtrl(ExpandoTextCtrl):
|
|
"""
|
|
Control used for in-place edit.
|
|
|
|
This is a subclass of :class:`lib.expando.ExpandoTextCtrl` as :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` supports multiline
|
|
text items.
|
|
|
|
:note: To add a newline character in a multiline item, press ``Shift`` + ``Enter`` as the ``Enter``
|
|
key alone is consumed by :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` to finish the editing and ``Ctrl`` + ``Enter`` is
|
|
consumed by the platform for tab navigation.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, owner, item=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param `owner`: the control parent (an instance of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`);
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` when the item has an associated image but the parent
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` does not have a :class:`ImageList` assigned.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._owner = owner
|
|
self._itemEdited = item
|
|
self._startValue = item.GetText()
|
|
self._finished = False
|
|
self._aboutToFinish = False
|
|
self._currentValue = self._startValue
|
|
|
|
w = self._itemEdited.GetWidth()
|
|
h = self._itemEdited.GetHeight()
|
|
|
|
wnd = self._itemEdited.GetWindow()
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
w = w - self._itemEdited.GetWindowSize()[0]
|
|
h = 0
|
|
|
|
x, y = self._owner.CalcScrolledPosition(item.GetX(), item.GetY())
|
|
|
|
image_h = 0
|
|
image_w = 0
|
|
|
|
image = item.GetCurrentImage()
|
|
|
|
if image != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
|
|
if self._owner._imageListNormal:
|
|
image_w, image_h = self._owner._imageListNormal.GetSize(image)
|
|
image_w += 4
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
raise Exception("\n ERROR: You Must Create An Image List To Use Images!")
|
|
|
|
checkimage = item.GetCurrentCheckedImage()
|
|
|
|
if checkimage is not None:
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = self._owner._imageListCheck.GetSize(checkimage)
|
|
wcheck += 4
|
|
else:
|
|
wcheck = hcheck = 0
|
|
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
h = max(hcheck, image_h)
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self._owner)
|
|
h = max(h, dc.GetTextExtent("Aq")[1])
|
|
h = h + 2
|
|
|
|
# FIXME: what are all these hardcoded 4, 8 and 11s really?
|
|
x += image_w + wcheck
|
|
w -= image_w + 4 + wcheck
|
|
|
|
expandoStyle = wx.WANTS_CHARS
|
|
if wx.Platform in ["__WXGTK__", "__WXMAC__"]:
|
|
expandoStyle |= wx.SIMPLE_BORDER
|
|
xSize, ySize = w + 25, h
|
|
else:
|
|
expandoStyle |= wx.SUNKEN_BORDER
|
|
xSize, ySize = w + 25, h+2
|
|
|
|
ExpandoTextCtrl.__init__(self, self._owner, wx.ID_ANY, self._startValue,
|
|
wx.Point(x - 4, y), wx.Size(xSize, ySize),
|
|
expandoStyle)
|
|
|
|
if wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__":
|
|
self.SetFont(owner.GetFont())
|
|
bs = self.GetBestSize()
|
|
self.SetSize((-1, bs.height))
|
|
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_CHAR, self.OnChar)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_KEY_UP, self.OnKeyUp)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_KILL_FOCUS, self.OnKillFocus)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AcceptChanges(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Accepts/rejects the changes made by the user.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the changes to the item text have been accepted, ``False``
|
|
if they have been rejected (i.e., vetoed by the user).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
value = self.GetValue()
|
|
|
|
if value == self._startValue:
|
|
# nothing changed, always accept
|
|
# when an item remains unchanged, the owner
|
|
# needs to be notified that the user decided
|
|
# not to change the tree item label, and that
|
|
# the edit has been cancelled
|
|
self._owner.OnCancelEdit(self._itemEdited)
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
if not self._owner.OnAcceptEdit(self._itemEdited, value):
|
|
# vetoed by the user
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
# accepted, do rename the item
|
|
self._owner.SetItemText(self._itemEdited, value)
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Finish(self):
|
|
""" Finish editing. """
|
|
|
|
if not self._finished:
|
|
self._finished = True
|
|
self._owner.SetFocusIgnoringChildren()
|
|
self._owner.ResetEditControl()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnChar(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_CHAR`` event for :class:`TreeTextCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`KeyEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
keycode = event.GetKeyCode()
|
|
shiftDown = event.ShiftDown()
|
|
|
|
if keycode in [wx.WXK_RETURN, wx.WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER]:
|
|
if shiftDown:
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
else:
|
|
self._aboutToFinish = True
|
|
self.SetValue(self._currentValue)
|
|
# Notify the owner about the changes
|
|
self.AcceptChanges()
|
|
# Even if vetoed, close the control (consistent with MSW)
|
|
wx.CallAfter(self.Finish)
|
|
|
|
elif keycode == wx.WXK_ESCAPE:
|
|
self.StopEditing()
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnKeyUp(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_KEY_UP`` event for :class:`TreeTextCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`KeyEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._finished:
|
|
|
|
# auto-grow the textctrl:
|
|
parentSize = self._owner.GetSize()
|
|
myPos = self.GetPosition()
|
|
mySize = self.GetSize()
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
sx, sy, dummy = dc.GetFullMultiLineTextExtent(self.GetValue() + "M")
|
|
|
|
if myPos.x + sx > parentSize.x:
|
|
sx = parentSize.x - myPos.x
|
|
if mySize.x > sx:
|
|
sx = mySize.x
|
|
|
|
self.SetSize((sx, -1))
|
|
self._currentValue = self.GetValue()
|
|
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnKillFocus(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_KILL_FOCUS`` event for :class:`TreeTextCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`FocusEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._finished and not self._aboutToFinish:
|
|
|
|
# We must finish regardless of success, otherwise we'll get
|
|
# focus problems:
|
|
|
|
if not self.AcceptChanges():
|
|
self._owner.OnCancelEdit(self._itemEdited)
|
|
|
|
# We must let the native text control handle focus, too, otherwise
|
|
# it could have problems with the cursor (e.g., in wxGTK).
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def StopEditing(self):
|
|
""" Suddenly stops the editing. """
|
|
|
|
self._owner.OnCancelEdit(self._itemEdited)
|
|
self.Finish()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def item(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item currently edited.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._itemEdited
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# Auxiliary Classes: TreeFindTimer
|
|
# Timer Used To Clear CustomTreeCtrl._findPrefix If No Key Was Pressed For A
|
|
# Sufficiently Long Time.
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class TreeFindTimer(wx.Timer):
|
|
"""
|
|
Timer used to clear the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` `_findPrefix` attribute if no
|
|
key was pressed for a sufficiently long time.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, owner):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param `owner`: the :class:`Timer` owner (an instance of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
wx.Timer.__init__(self)
|
|
self._owner = owner
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Notify(self):
|
|
""" The timer has expired, clear the `_findPrefix` attribute in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`. """
|
|
|
|
self._owner._findPrefix = ""
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# GenericTreeItem Implementation.
|
|
# This Class Holds All The Information And Methods For Every Single Item In
|
|
# CustomTreeCtrl.
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class GenericTreeItem(object):
|
|
"""
|
|
This class holds all the information and methods for every single item in
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl`. This is a generic implementation of :class:`TreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, parent, text="", ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None, separator=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
For internal use: do not call it in your code!
|
|
|
|
:param `parent`: the tree item parent, an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` (may
|
|
be ``None`` for root items);
|
|
:param string `text`: the tree item text;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the tree item kind. May be one of the following integers:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`ct_type` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 A normal item
|
|
1 A checkbox-like item
|
|
2 A radiobutton-type item
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to be displayed next to
|
|
the item, an instance of :class:`Window`;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item;
|
|
:param bool `separator`: ``True`` if the item is a separator, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: Regarding radiobutton-type items (with `ct_type` = 2), the following
|
|
approach is used:
|
|
|
|
- All peer-nodes that are radiobuttons will be mutually exclusive. In other words,
|
|
only one of a set of radiobuttons that share a common parent can be checked at
|
|
once. If a radiobutton node becomes checked, then all of its peer radiobuttons
|
|
must be unchecked.
|
|
- If a radiobutton node becomes unchecked, then all of its child nodes will become
|
|
inactive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
:note: Separator items should not have children, labels, data or an associated window.
|
|
Other issues/features associated to separator items:
|
|
|
|
- You can change the color of individual separators by using :meth:`CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemTextColour() <customtreectrl.CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemTextColour>`,
|
|
or you can use :meth:`CustomTreeCtrl.SetSeparatorColour() <customtreectrl.CustomTreeCtrl.SetSeparatorColour>` to change the color of all
|
|
separators. The default separator colour is that returned by `SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_GRAYTEXT)`;
|
|
- Separators can be selected just like any other tree item;
|
|
- Separators cannot have text;
|
|
- Separators cannot have children;
|
|
- Separators cannot be edited via the ``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` event.
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# since there can be very many of these, we save size by chosing
|
|
# the smallest representation for the elements and by ordering
|
|
# the members to avoid padding.
|
|
self._text = text # label to be rendered for item
|
|
self._data = data # user-provided data
|
|
|
|
self._children = [] # list of children
|
|
self._parent = parent # parent of this item
|
|
|
|
self._attr = None # attributes???
|
|
|
|
self._separator = separator
|
|
|
|
# tree ctrl images for the normal, selected, expanded and
|
|
# expanded+selected states
|
|
self._images = [-1, -1, -1, -1]
|
|
self._images[TreeItemIcon_Normal] = image
|
|
self._images[TreeItemIcon_Selected] = selImage
|
|
self._images[TreeItemIcon_Expanded] = _NO_IMAGE
|
|
self._images[TreeItemIcon_SelectedExpanded] = _NO_IMAGE
|
|
|
|
self._checkedimages = [None, None, None, None, None]
|
|
self._leftimage = _NO_IMAGE
|
|
|
|
self._x = 0 # (virtual) offset from top
|
|
self._y = 0 # (virtual) offset from left
|
|
self._width = 0 # width of this item
|
|
self._height = 0 # height of this item
|
|
|
|
self._isCollapsed = True
|
|
self._hasHilight = False # same as focused
|
|
self._hasPlus = False # used for item which doesn't have
|
|
# children but has a [+] button
|
|
self._isBold = False # render the label in bold font
|
|
self._isItalic = False # render the label in italic font
|
|
self._ownsAttr = False # delete attribute when done
|
|
self._type = ct_type # item type: 0=normal, 1=check, 2=radio
|
|
self._is3State = False # true for 3-state checkbox items
|
|
self._checked = 0 # only meaningful for check and radio items
|
|
self._enabled = True # flag to enable/disable an item
|
|
self._hypertext = False # indicates if the item is hypertext
|
|
self._visited = False # visited state for an hypertext item
|
|
|
|
if self._type > 0:
|
|
# do not construct the array for normal items
|
|
self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_Checked] = 0
|
|
self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_NotChecked] = 1
|
|
self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_Undetermined] = 2
|
|
self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_Flagged] = 3
|
|
self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_NotFlagged] = 4
|
|
|
|
if parent:
|
|
if parent.GetType() == 2 and not parent.IsChecked():
|
|
# if the node parent is a radio not enabled, we are disabled
|
|
self._enabled = False
|
|
|
|
self._wnd = wnd # are we holding a window?
|
|
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
self.SetWindow(wnd)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsOk(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is ok or not.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method always returns ``True``, it has been added for
|
|
backward compatibility with the wxWidgets C++ implementation.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsSeparator(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is meant to be an horizontal line separator or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if this item is a separator, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._separator
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetChildren(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item's children.
|
|
|
|
:return: A Python list containing instances of :class:`GenericTreeItem`, representing
|
|
this item's children.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._children
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetText(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item text.
|
|
|
|
:return: A string containing the item text.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._text
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetImage(self, which=TreeItemIcon_Normal):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item image for a particular item state.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `which`: can be one of the following bits:
|
|
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
Item State Description
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Normal`` To get the normal item image
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Selected`` To get the selected item image (i.e. the image which is shown when the item is currently selected)
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Expanded`` To get the expanded image (this only makes sense for items which have children - then this image is shown when the item is expanded and the normal image is shown when it is collapsed)
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_SelectedExpanded`` To get the selected expanded image (which is shown when an expanded item is currently selected)
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._images[which]
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetCheckedImage(self, which=TreeItemIcon_Checked):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item check image.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `which`: can be one of the following bits:
|
|
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
Item State Description
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Checked`` To get the checkbox checked item image
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_NotChecked`` To get the checkbox unchecked item image
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Undetermined`` To get the checkbox undetermined state item image
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Flagged`` To get the radiobutton checked image
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_NotFlagged`` To get the radiobutton unchecked image
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item check image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for radio & check items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._checkedimages[which]
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetLeftImage(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the leftmost image associated to this item, i.e. the image on the
|
|
leftmost part of the client area of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item leftmost image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._leftimage
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetData(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the data associated to this item.
|
|
|
|
:return: A Python object representing the item data, or ``None`` if no data
|
|
has been assigned to this item.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._data
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetImage(self, image, which):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item image.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to use;
|
|
:param integer `which`: the image kind.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~GenericTreeItem.GetImage` for a description of the `which` parameter.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._images[which] = image
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetLeftImage(self, image):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item leftmost image, i.e. the image associated to the item on the leftmost
|
|
part of the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` client area.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the left image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in the leftmost part of the client area.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._leftimage = image
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetData(self, data):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the data associated to this item.
|
|
|
|
:param object `data`: can be any Python object.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._data = data
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHasPlus(self, has=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether an item has the 'plus' button.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `has`: ``True`` to set the 'plus' button on the item, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hasPlus = has
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetBold(self, bold):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item font bold.
|
|
|
|
:parameter bool `bold`: ``True`` to have a bold font item, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._isBold = bold
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItalic(self, italic):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item font italic.
|
|
|
|
:parameter bool `italic`: ``True`` to have an italic font item, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._isItalic = italic
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetX(self):
|
|
""" Returns the `x` position on an item, in logical coordinates. """
|
|
|
|
return self._x
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetY(self):
|
|
""" Returns the `y` position on an item, in logical coordinates. """
|
|
|
|
return self._y
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetX(self, x):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the `x` position on an item, in logical coordinates.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `x`: an integer specifying the x position of the item.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._x = x
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetY(self, y):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the `y` position on an item, in logical coordinates.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `y`: an integer specifying the y position of the item.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._y = y
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetHeight(self):
|
|
""" Returns the height of the item, in pixels. """
|
|
|
|
return self._height
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetWidth(self):
|
|
""" Returns the width of the item, in pixels. """
|
|
|
|
return self._width
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHeight(self, h):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item's height.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `h`: an integer specifying the item's height, in pixels.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._height = h
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetWidth(self, w):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item's width.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `w`: an integer specifying the item's width, in pixels.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._width = w
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetWindow(self, wnd):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the window associated to the item.
|
|
|
|
:param `wnd`: a non-toplevel window to be displayed next to the item, any
|
|
subclass of :class:`Window`.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if the input `item` is a separator and `wnd` is not ``None``.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.IsSeparator() and wnd is not None:
|
|
raise Exception("Separator items can not have an associated window")
|
|
|
|
self._wnd = wnd
|
|
|
|
if wnd.GetSizer(): # the window is a complex one hold by a sizer
|
|
size = wnd.GetBestSize()
|
|
else: # simple window, without sizers
|
|
size = wnd.GetSize()
|
|
|
|
# We have to bind the wx.EVT_SET_FOCUS for the associated window
|
|
# No other solution to handle the focus changing from an item in
|
|
# CustomTreeCtrl and the window associated to an item
|
|
# Do better strategies exist?
|
|
self._wnd.Bind(wx.EVT_SET_FOCUS, self.OnSetFocus)
|
|
|
|
self._height = size.GetHeight() + 2
|
|
self._width = size.GetWidth()
|
|
self._windowsize = size
|
|
|
|
# We don't show the window if the item is collapsed
|
|
if self._isCollapsed:
|
|
self._wnd.Show(False)
|
|
|
|
# The window is enabled only if the item is enabled
|
|
self._wnd.Enable(self._enabled)
|
|
self._windowenabled = self._enabled
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetWindow(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the window associated to the item (if any).
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of any :class:`Window` derived class, excluding top-level windows.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._wnd
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DeleteWindow(self):
|
|
""" Deletes the window associated to the item (if any). """
|
|
|
|
if self._wnd:
|
|
self._wnd.Destroy()
|
|
self._wnd = None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetWindowEnabled(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the associated window is enabled or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the associated window is enabled, ``False`` if it is disabled.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` when the item has no associated window.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._wnd:
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: This Item Has No Window Associated")
|
|
|
|
return self._windowenabled
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetWindowEnabled(self, enable=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether the associated window is enabled or not.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable the associated window, ``False`` to disable it.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` when the item has no associated window.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._wnd:
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: This Item Has No Window Associated")
|
|
|
|
self._windowenabled = enable
|
|
self._wnd.Enable(enable)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetWindowSize(self):
|
|
""" Returns the associated window size. """
|
|
|
|
return self._windowsize
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnSetFocus(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_SET_FOCUS`` event for the window associated with the item.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`FocusEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
treectrl = self._wnd.GetParent()
|
|
select = treectrl.GetSelection()
|
|
|
|
# If the window is associated to an item that currently is selected
|
|
# (has focus) we don't kill the focus. Otherwise we do it.
|
|
if select != self:
|
|
treectrl._hasFocus = False
|
|
else:
|
|
treectrl._hasFocus = True
|
|
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetType(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item type.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~GenericTreeItem.SetType` and :meth:`~GenericTreeItem.__init__` for a description of valid item types.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._type
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetType(self, ct_type):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item type.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: may be one of the following integers:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`ct_type` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 A normal item
|
|
1 A checkbox-like item
|
|
2 A radiobutton-type item
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
|
|
:note: Regarding radiobutton-type items (with `ct_type` = 2), the following
|
|
approach is used:
|
|
|
|
- All peer-nodes that are radiobuttons will be mutually exclusive. In other words,
|
|
only one of a set of radiobuttons that share a common parent can be checked at
|
|
once. If a radiobutton node becomes checked, then all of its peer radiobuttons
|
|
must be unchecked.
|
|
- If a radiobutton node becomes unchecked, then all of its child nodes will become
|
|
inactive.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._type = ct_type
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHyperText(self, hyper=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether the item is hypertext or not.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `hyper`: ``True`` to set hypertext behaviour, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hypertext = hyper
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetVisited(self, visited=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether an hypertext item was visited or not.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `visited`: ``True`` to set a hypertext item as visited, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._visited = visited
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetVisited(self):
|
|
""" Returns whether an hypertext item was visited or not. """
|
|
|
|
return self._visited
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsHyperText(self):
|
|
""" Returns whether the item is hypetext or not. """
|
|
|
|
return self._hypertext
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetParent(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gets the item parent (another instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` for
|
|
root items.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` for root items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._parent
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Insert(self, child, index):
|
|
"""
|
|
Inserts an item in the item children list for this item.
|
|
|
|
:param `child`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `index`: the index at which we should insert the new child.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._children.insert(index, child)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Expand(self):
|
|
""" Expands the item. """
|
|
|
|
self._isCollapsed = False
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Collapse(self):
|
|
""" Collapses the item. """
|
|
|
|
self._isCollapsed = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHilight(self, set=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item focus/unfocus.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `set`: ``True`` to set the focus to the item, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hasHilight = set
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasChildren(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item has children or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has children, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return len(self._children) > 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsSelected(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is selected or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is selected, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hasHilight != 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsExpanded(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is expanded or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is expanded, ``False`` if it is collapsed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return not self._isCollapsed
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetValue(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is checked or not.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.Is3State():
|
|
return self.Get3StateValue()
|
|
|
|
return self._checked
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Get3StateValue(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gets the state of a 3-state checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``wx.CHK_UNCHECKED`` when the checkbox is unchecked, ``wx.CHK_CHECKED``
|
|
when it is checked and ``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED`` when it's in the undetermined
|
|
state.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` when the item is not a 3-state checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method raises an exception when the function is used with a 2-state
|
|
checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self.Is3State():
|
|
raise Exception("Get3StateValue can only be used with 3-state checkbox items.")
|
|
|
|
return self._checked
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Is3State(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether or not the checkbox item is a 3-state checkbox.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if this checkbox is a 3-state checkbox, ``False`` if it's a
|
|
2-state checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._is3State
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Set3StateValue(self, state):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the checkbox item to the given `state`.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `state`: can be one of: ``wx.CHK_UNCHECKED`` (check is off), ``wx.CHK_CHECKED``
|
|
(check is on) or ``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED`` (check is mixed).
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` when the item is not a 3-state checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method raises an exception when the checkbox item is a 2-state checkbox
|
|
and setting the state to ``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED``.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._is3State and state == wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED:
|
|
raise Exception("Set3StateValue can only be used with 3-state checkbox items.")
|
|
|
|
self._checked = state
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Set3State(self, allow):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether the item has a 3-state value checkbox assigned to it or not.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `allow`: ``True`` to set an item as a 3-state checkbox, ``False`` to set it
|
|
to a 2-state checkbox.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the change was successful, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._type != 1:
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
self._is3State = allow
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsChecked(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
This is just a maybe more readable synonym for :meth:`~GenericTreeItem.GetValue`.
|
|
Returns whether the item is checked or not.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.GetValue()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Check(self, checked=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Checks/unchecks an item.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._checked = checked
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasPlus(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item has the plus button or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has a 'plus' mark, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hasPlus or self.HasChildren()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsBold(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item font is bold or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has bold text, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._isBold != 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItalic(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item font is italic or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has italic text, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._isItalic != 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Enable(self, enable=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Enables/disables the item.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable the item, ``False`` to disable it.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._enabled = enable
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsEnabled(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is enabled or not.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is enabled, ``False`` if it is disabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._enabled
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetAttributes(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item attributes (font, colours, etc...).
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`TreeItemAttr`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._attr
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Attr(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Creates a new attribute (font, colours, etc...) for this item.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`TreeItemAttr`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._attr:
|
|
|
|
self._attr = TreeItemAttr()
|
|
self._ownsAttr = True
|
|
|
|
return self._attr
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetAttributes(self, attr):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item attributes (font, colours, etc...).
|
|
|
|
:param `attr`: an instance of :class:`TreeItemAttr`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._ownsAttr:
|
|
del self._attr
|
|
|
|
self._attr = attr
|
|
self._ownsAttr = False
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AssignAttributes(self, attr):
|
|
"""
|
|
Assigns the item attributes (font, colours, etc...) for this item.
|
|
|
|
:param `attr`: an instance of :class:`TreeItemAttr`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.SetAttributes(attr)
|
|
self._ownsAttr = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DeleteChildren(self, tree):
|
|
"""
|
|
Deletes the item children.
|
|
|
|
:param `tree`: the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` instance.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
for child in self._children:
|
|
if tree:
|
|
tree.SendDeleteEvent(child)
|
|
|
|
child.DeleteChildren(tree)
|
|
|
|
if child == tree._select_me:
|
|
tree._select_me = None
|
|
|
|
# We have to destroy the associated window
|
|
wnd = child.GetWindow()
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
wnd.Destroy()
|
|
child._wnd = None
|
|
|
|
if child in tree._itemWithWindow:
|
|
tree._itemWithWindow.remove(child)
|
|
|
|
del child
|
|
|
|
self._children = []
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetText(self, text):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item text.
|
|
|
|
:param string `text`: the new item label.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if the item is a separator.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.IsSeparator():
|
|
raise Exception("Separator items can not have text")
|
|
|
|
self._text = text
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetChildrenCount(self, recursively=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gets the number of children of this item.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `recursively`: if ``True``, returns the total number of descendants,
|
|
otherwise only one level of children is counted.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
count = len(self._children)
|
|
|
|
if not recursively:
|
|
return count
|
|
|
|
total = count
|
|
|
|
for n in range(count):
|
|
total += self._children[n].GetChildrenCount()
|
|
|
|
return total
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetSize(self, x, y, theButton):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item size.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `x`: the current item's x position;
|
|
:param integer `y`: the current item's y position;
|
|
:param `theButton`: an instance of the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:return: A tuple of (`x`, `y`) dimensions, in pixels, representing the
|
|
item's width and height.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
bottomY = self._y + theButton.GetLineHeight(self)
|
|
|
|
if y < bottomY:
|
|
y = bottomY
|
|
|
|
width = self._x + self._width
|
|
|
|
if x < width:
|
|
x = width
|
|
|
|
if self.IsExpanded():
|
|
for child in self._children:
|
|
x, y = child.GetSize(x, y, theButton)
|
|
|
|
return x, y
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HitTest(self, point, theCtrl, flags=0, level=0):
|
|
"""
|
|
:meth:`~GenericTreeItem.HitTest` method for an item. Called from the main window :meth:`CustomTreeCtrl.HitTest() <customtreectrl.CustomTreeCtrl.HitTest>`.
|
|
|
|
:param `point`: the point to test for the hit (an instance of :class:`Point`);
|
|
:param `theCtrl`: the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` tree;
|
|
:param integer `flags`: a bitlist of hit locations;
|
|
:param integer `level`: the item's level inside the tree hierarchy.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`CustomTreeCtrl.HitTest() <customtreectrl.CustomTreeCtrl.HitTest>` method for the flags explanation.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# for a hidden root node, don't evaluate it, but do evaluate children
|
|
if not (level == 0 and theCtrl.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT)):
|
|
|
|
# evaluate the item
|
|
h = theCtrl.GetLineHeight(self)
|
|
|
|
pointX, pointY = point[0], point[1]
|
|
if pointY > self._y and pointY < self._y + h:
|
|
|
|
y_mid = self._y + h//2
|
|
|
|
if pointY < y_mid:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMUPPERPART
|
|
else:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLOWERPART
|
|
|
|
xCross = self._x - theCtrl.GetSpacing()
|
|
|
|
if wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__":
|
|
# according to the drawing code the triangels are drawn
|
|
# at -4 , -4 from the position up to +10/+10 max
|
|
if pointX > xCross-4 and pointX < xCross+10 and pointY > y_mid-4 and \
|
|
pointY < y_mid+10 and self.HasPlus() and theCtrl.HasButtons():
|
|
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMBUTTON
|
|
return self, flags
|
|
else:
|
|
# 5 is the size of the plus sign
|
|
if pointX > xCross-6 and pointX < xCross+6 and pointY > y_mid-6 and \
|
|
pointY < y_mid+6 and self.HasPlus() and theCtrl.HasButtons():
|
|
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMBUTTON
|
|
return self, flags
|
|
|
|
if pointX >= self._x and pointX <= self._x + self._width:
|
|
|
|
image_w = -1
|
|
wcheck = 0
|
|
|
|
# assuming every image (normal and selected) has the same size!
|
|
if self.GetImage() != _NO_IMAGE and theCtrl._imageListNormal:
|
|
image_w, image_h = theCtrl._imageListNormal.GetSize(self.GetImage())
|
|
|
|
if self.GetCheckedImage() is not None:
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = theCtrl._imageListCheck.GetSize(self.GetCheckedImage())
|
|
|
|
if wcheck and pointX <= self._x + wcheck + 1:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMCHECKICON
|
|
return self, flags
|
|
|
|
if image_w != -1 and pointX <= self._x + wcheck + image_w + 1:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMICON
|
|
else:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL
|
|
|
|
return self, flags
|
|
|
|
if pointX < self._x:
|
|
if theCtrl.HasAGWFlag(TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT):
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM
|
|
else:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMINDENT
|
|
if pointX > self._x + self._width:
|
|
if theCtrl.HasAGWFlag(TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT):
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM
|
|
else:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMRIGHT
|
|
|
|
return self, flags
|
|
|
|
# if children are expanded, fall through to evaluate them
|
|
if self._isCollapsed:
|
|
return None, 0
|
|
|
|
# evaluate children
|
|
for child in self._children:
|
|
res, flags = child.HitTest(point, theCtrl, flags, level + 1)
|
|
if res != None:
|
|
return res, flags
|
|
|
|
return None, 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetCurrentImage(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the current item image.
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
image = _NO_IMAGE
|
|
|
|
if self.IsExpanded():
|
|
|
|
if self.IsSelected():
|
|
|
|
image = self._images[TreeItemIcon_SelectedExpanded]
|
|
|
|
if image == _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
|
|
# we usually fall back to the normal item, but try just the
|
|
# expanded one (and not selected) first in this case
|
|
image = self._images[TreeItemIcon_Expanded]
|
|
|
|
else: # not expanded
|
|
|
|
if self.IsSelected():
|
|
image = self._images[TreeItemIcon_Selected]
|
|
|
|
# maybe it doesn't have the specific image we want,
|
|
# try the default one instead
|
|
if image == _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
image = self._images[TreeItemIcon_Normal]
|
|
|
|
return image
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetCurrentCheckedImage(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the current item check image.
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item check image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._type == 0:
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
checked = self.IsChecked()
|
|
|
|
if checked > 0:
|
|
if self._type == 1: # Checkbox
|
|
if checked == wx.CHK_CHECKED:
|
|
return self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_Checked]
|
|
else:
|
|
return self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_Undetermined]
|
|
else: # Radiobutton
|
|
return self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_Flagged]
|
|
else:
|
|
if self._type == 1: # Checkbox
|
|
return self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_NotChecked]
|
|
else: # Radiobutton
|
|
return self._checkedimages[TreeItemIcon_NotFlagged]
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# CustomTreeCtrl Main Implementation.
|
|
# This Is The Main Class.
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
class CustomTreeCtrl(wx.ScrolledWindow):
|
|
"""
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is a class that mimics the behaviour of :class:`TreeCtrl`, with almost the
|
|
same base functionalities plus some more enhancements. This class does not rely on
|
|
the native control, as it is a full owner-drawn tree control.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, parent, id=wx.ID_ANY, pos=wx.DefaultPosition, size=wx.DefaultSize,
|
|
style=0, agwStyle=TR_DEFAULT_STYLE, validator=wx.DefaultValidator,
|
|
name="CustomTreeCtrl"):
|
|
"""
|
|
Default class constructor.
|
|
|
|
:param Window `parent`: parent window. Must not be ``None``;
|
|
:param integer `id`: window identifier. A value of -1 indicates a default value;
|
|
:param `pos`: the control position. A value of (-1, -1) indicates a default position,
|
|
chosen by either the windowing system or wxPython, depending on platform;
|
|
:type `pos`: tuple or :class:`Point`
|
|
:param `size`: the control size. A value of (-1, -1) indicates a default size,
|
|
chosen by either the windowing system or wxPython, depending on platform;
|
|
:type `size`: tuple or :class:`Size`
|
|
:param integer `style`: the underlying :class:`ScrolledWindow` style;
|
|
:param integer `agwStyle`: the AGW-specific window style for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`. It can be a
|
|
combination of the following bits:
|
|
|
|
============================== =========== ==================================================
|
|
Window Styles Hex Value Description
|
|
============================== =========== ==================================================
|
|
``TR_NO_BUTTONS`` 0x0 For convenience to document that no buttons are to be drawn.
|
|
``TR_SINGLE`` 0x0 For convenience to document that only one item may be selected at a time. Selecting another item causes the current selection, if any, to be deselected. This is the default.
|
|
``TR_HAS_BUTTONS`` 0x1 Use this style to show + and - buttons to the left of parent items.
|
|
``TR_NO_LINES`` 0x4 Use this style to hide vertical level connectors.
|
|
``TR_LINES_AT_ROOT`` 0x8 Use this style to show lines between root nodes. Only applicable if ``TR_HIDE_ROOT`` is set and ``TR_NO_LINES`` is not set.
|
|
``TR_DEFAULT_STYLE`` 0x9 The set of flags that are closest to the defaults for the native control for a particular toolkit.
|
|
``TR_TWIST_BUTTONS`` 0x10 Use old Mac-twist style buttons.
|
|
``TR_MULTIPLE`` 0x20 Use this style to allow a range of items to be selected. If a second range is selected, the current range, if any, is deselected.
|
|
``TR_EXTENDED`` 0x40 Use this style to allow disjoint items to be selected. (Only partially implemented; may not work in all cases).
|
|
``TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT`` 0x80 Use this style to cause row heights to be just big enough to fit the content. If not set, all rows use the largest row height. The default is that this flag is unset.
|
|
``TR_EDIT_LABELS`` 0x200 Use this style if you wish the user to be able to edit labels in the tree control.
|
|
``TR_ROW_LINES`` 0x400 Use this style to draw a contrasting border between displayed rows.
|
|
``TR_HIDE_ROOT`` 0x800 Use this style to suppress the display of the root node, effectively causing the first-level nodes to appear as a series of root nodes.
|
|
``TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT`` 0x2000 Use this style to have the background colour and the selection highlight extend over the entire horizontal row of the tree control window.
|
|
``TR_AUTO_CHECK_CHILD`` 0x4000 Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a parent item is checked/unchecked its children are checked/unchecked as well.
|
|
``TR_AUTO_TOGGLE_CHILD`` 0x8000 Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a parent item is checked/unchecked its children are toggled accordingly.
|
|
``TR_AUTO_CHECK_PARENT`` 0x10000 Only meaningful for checkbox-type items: when a child item is checked/unchecked its parent item is checked/unchecked as well.
|
|
``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS`` 0x20000 Flag used to align windows (in items with windows) at the same horizontal position.
|
|
``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT`` 0x40000 Flag used to align windows (in items with windows) to the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
``TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS`` 0x80000 Flag used to ellipsize long items when the horizontal space for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low.
|
|
``TR_TOOLTIP_ON_LONG_ITEMS`` 0x100000 Flag used to show tooltips on long items when the horizontal space for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is low.
|
|
============================== =========== ==================================================
|
|
|
|
:param Validator `validator`: window validator;
|
|
:param string `name`: window name.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._current = self._key_current = self._anchor = self._select_me = None
|
|
self._hasFocus = False
|
|
self._dirty = False
|
|
|
|
# Default line height: it will soon be changed
|
|
self._lineHeight = 10
|
|
# Item indent wrt parent
|
|
self._indent = 15
|
|
# item horizontal spacing between the start and the text
|
|
self._spacing = 18
|
|
|
|
# Brushes for focused/unfocused items (also gradient type)
|
|
self._hilightBrush = wx.Brush(wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT))
|
|
btnshadow = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_BTNSHADOW)
|
|
self._hilightUnfocusedBrush = wx.Brush(btnshadow)
|
|
r, g, b = btnshadow.Red(), btnshadow.Green(), btnshadow.Blue()
|
|
backcolour = (max((r >> 1) - 20, 0),
|
|
max((g >> 1) - 20, 0),
|
|
max((b >> 1) - 20, 0))
|
|
backcolour = wx.Colour(backcolour[0], backcolour[1], backcolour[2])
|
|
self._hilightUnfocusedBrush2 = wx.Brush(backcolour)
|
|
|
|
# image list for icons
|
|
self._imageListNormal = self._imageListButtons = self._imageListState = self._imageListCheck = self._imageListLeft = None
|
|
self._ownsImageListNormal = self._ownsImageListButtons = self._ownsImageListState = self._ownsImageListLeft = False
|
|
|
|
# Drag and drop initial settings
|
|
self._dragCount = 0
|
|
self._countDrag = 0
|
|
self._isDragging = False
|
|
self._dropTarget = self._oldSelection = None
|
|
self._dragImage = None
|
|
self._underMouse = None
|
|
|
|
# EditCtrl initial settings for editable items
|
|
self._editCtrl = None
|
|
self._editTimer = None
|
|
|
|
# This one allows us to handle Freeze() and Thaw() calls
|
|
self._freezeCount = 0
|
|
|
|
self._findPrefix = ""
|
|
self._findTimer = None
|
|
|
|
self._dropEffectAboveItem = False
|
|
self._lastOnSame = False
|
|
|
|
# Default normal and bold fonts for an item
|
|
self._hasFont = True
|
|
self._normalFont = wx.SystemSettings.GetFont(wx.SYS_DEFAULT_GUI_FONT)
|
|
family = self._normalFont.GetFamily()
|
|
if family == wx.FONTFAMILY_UNKNOWN:
|
|
family = wx.FONTFAMILY_SWISS
|
|
self._boldFont = wx.Font(self._normalFont.GetPointSize(), family,
|
|
self._normalFont.GetStyle(), wx.FONTWEIGHT_BOLD, self._normalFont.GetUnderlined(),
|
|
self._normalFont.GetFaceName(), self._normalFont.GetEncoding())
|
|
self._italicFont = wx.Font(self._normalFont.GetPointSize(), family,
|
|
wx.FONTSTYLE_ITALIC, wx.FONTWEIGHT_NORMAL, self._normalFont.GetUnderlined(),
|
|
self._normalFont.GetFaceName(), self._normalFont.GetEncoding())
|
|
|
|
# Hyperlinks things
|
|
self._hypertextfont = wx.Font(self._normalFont.GetPointSize(), family,
|
|
self._normalFont.GetStyle(), wx.FONTWEIGHT_NORMAL, True,
|
|
self._normalFont.GetFaceName(), self._normalFont.GetEncoding())
|
|
self._hypertextnewcolour = wx.BLUE
|
|
self._hypertextvisitedcolour = wx.Colour(200, 47, 200)
|
|
self._isonhyperlink = False
|
|
|
|
# Default CustomTreeCtrl background colour.
|
|
self._backgroundColour = wx.WHITE
|
|
|
|
# Background image settings
|
|
self._backgroundImage = None
|
|
self._imageStretchStyle = _StyleTile
|
|
|
|
# Disabled items colour
|
|
self._disabledColour = wx.Colour(180, 180, 180)
|
|
|
|
# Gradient selection colours
|
|
self._firstcolour = colour = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT)
|
|
self._secondcolour = wx.WHITE
|
|
self._usegradients = False
|
|
self._gradientstyle = 0 # Horizontal Gradient
|
|
|
|
# Vista Selection Styles
|
|
self._vistaselection = False
|
|
|
|
# To speed up ExpandAll and SelectAll
|
|
self._sendEvent = True
|
|
|
|
# Connection lines style
|
|
grey = (160,160,160)
|
|
if wx.Platform != "__WXMAC__":
|
|
self._dottedPen = wx.Pen(grey, 1, wx.USER_DASH)
|
|
self._dottedPen.SetDashes([1,1])
|
|
self._dottedPen.SetCap(wx.CAP_BUTT)
|
|
else:
|
|
self._dottedPen = wx.Pen(grey, 1)
|
|
|
|
# Pen Used To Draw The Border Around Selected Items
|
|
self._borderPen = wx.BLACK_PEN
|
|
self._cursor = wx.Cursor(wx.CURSOR_ARROW)
|
|
|
|
# For Appended Windows
|
|
self._hasWindows = False
|
|
self._itemWithWindow = []
|
|
|
|
if wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__":
|
|
agwStyle &= ~TR_LINES_AT_ROOT
|
|
agwStyle |= TR_NO_LINES
|
|
|
|
platform, major, minor = wx.GetOsVersion()
|
|
if major < 10:
|
|
agwStyle |= TR_ROW_LINES
|
|
|
|
# A constant to use my translation of RendererNative.DrawTreeItemButton
|
|
# if the wxPython version is less than 2.6.2.1.
|
|
if _VERSION_STRING < "2.6.2.1":
|
|
self._drawingfunction = DrawTreeItemButton
|
|
else:
|
|
self._drawingfunction = wx.RendererNative.Get().DrawTreeItemButton
|
|
|
|
# Set the separator pen default colour
|
|
self._separatorPen = wx.Pen(wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_GRAYTEXT))
|
|
|
|
# Create our container... at last!
|
|
wx.ScrolledWindow.__init__(self, parent, id, pos, size, style|wx.HSCROLL|wx.VSCROLL, name)
|
|
|
|
self._agwStyle = agwStyle
|
|
|
|
# Create the default check image list
|
|
self.SetImageListCheck(16, 16)
|
|
|
|
# If the tree display has no buttons, but does have
|
|
# connecting lines, we can use a narrower layout.
|
|
# It may not be a good idea to force this...
|
|
if not self.HasButtons() and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_NO_LINES):
|
|
self._indent= 10
|
|
self._spacing = 10
|
|
|
|
self.SetValidator(validator)
|
|
|
|
attr = self.GetDefaultAttributes()
|
|
self.SetOwnForegroundColour(attr.colFg)
|
|
self.SetOwnBackgroundColour(attr.colBg)
|
|
|
|
if not self._hasFont:
|
|
self.SetOwnFont(attr.font)
|
|
|
|
self.SetSize(size)
|
|
|
|
# Bind the events
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_PAINT, self.OnPaint)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND, self.OnEraseBackground)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_SIZE, self.OnSize)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS, self.OnMouse)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_KEY_DOWN, self.OnKeyDown)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_SET_FOCUS, self.OnSetFocus)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_KILL_FOCUS, self.OnKillFocus)
|
|
self.Bind(EVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP, self.OnGetToolTip)
|
|
self.Bind(wx.EVT_WINDOW_DESTROY, self.OnDestroy)
|
|
|
|
# Sets the focus to ourselves: this is useful if you have items
|
|
# with associated widgets.
|
|
self.SetFocus()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AcceptsFocus(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Can this window be given focus by mouse click?
|
|
|
|
:note: This method always returns ``True`` as we always accept focus from
|
|
mouse click.
|
|
|
|
:note: Overridden from :class:`ScrolledWindow`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# overridden base class method, allows this ctrl to
|
|
# participate in the tab-order, etc. It's overridable because
|
|
# of deriving this class from wx.ScrolledWindow...
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnDestroy(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_WINDOW_DESTROY`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`WindowDestroyEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Here there may be something I miss... do I have to destroy
|
|
# something else?
|
|
if self._editTimer and self._editTimer.IsRunning():
|
|
self._editTimer.Stop()
|
|
del self._editTimer
|
|
self._editTimer = None
|
|
|
|
if self._findTimer and self._findTimer.IsRunning():
|
|
self._findTimer.Stop()
|
|
del self._findTimer
|
|
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetControlBmp(self, checkbox=True, checked=False, enabled=True, x=16, y=16):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns a native looking checkbox or radio button bitmap.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `checkbox`: ``True`` to get a checkbox image, ``False`` for a radiobutton one;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` if the control is marked, ``False`` if it is not;
|
|
:param bool `enabled`: ``True`` if the control is enabled, ``False`` if it is not;
|
|
:param integer `x`: the width of the bitmap;
|
|
:param integer `y`: the height of the bitmap.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Bitmap`, representing a native looking checkbox or radiobutton.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
bmp = wx.Bitmap(x, y)
|
|
mdc = wx.MemoryDC(bmp)
|
|
mask = wx.Colour(0xfe, 0xfe, 0xfe)
|
|
mdc.SetBackground(wx.Brush(mask))
|
|
mdc.Clear()
|
|
|
|
render = wx.RendererNative.Get()
|
|
|
|
if checked == wx.CHK_CHECKED:
|
|
flag = wx.CONTROL_CHECKED
|
|
elif checked == wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED:
|
|
flag = wx.CONTROL_UNDETERMINED
|
|
else:
|
|
flag = 0
|
|
|
|
if not enabled:
|
|
flag |= wx.CONTROL_DISABLED
|
|
|
|
if checkbox:
|
|
render.DrawCheckBox(self, mdc, (0, 0, x, y), flag)
|
|
else:
|
|
if _VERSION_STRING < "2.9":
|
|
render.DrawRadioButton(self, mdc, (0, 0, x, y), flag)
|
|
else:
|
|
render.DrawRadioBitmap(self, mdc, (0, 0, x, y), flag)
|
|
|
|
mdc.SelectObject(wx.NullBitmap)
|
|
bmp.SetMaskColour(mask)
|
|
return bmp
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetCount(self):
|
|
""" Returns the global number of items in the tree. """
|
|
|
|
if not self._anchor:
|
|
# the tree is empty
|
|
return 0
|
|
|
|
count = self._anchor.GetChildrenCount()
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
# take the root itself into account
|
|
count = count + 1
|
|
|
|
return count
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetIndent(self):
|
|
""" Returns the item indentation, in pixels. """
|
|
|
|
return self._indent
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetSpacing(self):
|
|
""" Returns the spacing between the start and the text, in pixels. """
|
|
|
|
return self._spacing
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetRootItem(self):
|
|
""" Returns the root item, an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`. """
|
|
|
|
return self._anchor
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetSelection(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the current selection.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:note:
|
|
|
|
This method is valid only with the style ``TR_SINGLE`` set. Use
|
|
:meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.GetSelections` for multiple-selections trees.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._current
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ToggleItemSelection(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Toggles the item selection.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.SelectItem(item, not self.IsSelected(item))
|
|
|
|
|
|
def EnableChildren(self, item, enable=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Enables/disables the item children.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable the children, ``False`` to disable them.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is used internally.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
torefresh = False
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
torefresh = True
|
|
|
|
if item.GetType() == 2 and enable and not item.IsChecked():
|
|
# We hit a radiobutton item not checked, we don't want to
|
|
# enable the children
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(item)
|
|
while child:
|
|
self.EnableItem(child, enable, torefresh=torefresh)
|
|
# Recurse on tree
|
|
if child.GetType != 2 or (child.GetType() == 2 and item.IsChecked()):
|
|
self.EnableChildren(child, enable)
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def EnableItem(self, item, enable=True, torefresh=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Enables/disables an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable the item, ``False`` to disable it;
|
|
:param bool `torefresh`: whether to redraw the item or not.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsEnabled() == enable:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if not enable and item.IsSelected():
|
|
self.SelectItem(item, False)
|
|
|
|
item.Enable(enable)
|
|
wnd = item.GetWindow()
|
|
|
|
# Handles the eventual window associated to the item
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
wndenable = item.GetWindowEnabled()
|
|
wnd.Enable(enable)
|
|
|
|
if torefresh:
|
|
# We have to refresh the item line
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self.CalculateSize(item, dc)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItemEnabled(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether an item is enabled or disabled.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsEnabled()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetDisabledColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the colour for items in a disabled state.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._disabledColour = colour
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetDisabledColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the colour for items in a disabled state.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._disabledColour
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItemChecked(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether an item is checked or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is in a 'checked' state, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsChecked()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItem3StateValue(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gets the state of a 3-state checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``wx.CHK_UNCHECKED`` when the checkbox is unchecked, ``wx.CHK_CHECKED``
|
|
when it is checked and ``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED`` when it's in the undetermined
|
|
state.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method raises an exception when the function is used with a 2-state
|
|
checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.Get3StateValue()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItem3State(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether or not the checkbox item is a 3-state checkbox.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if this checkbox is a 3-state checkbox, ``False`` if it's a
|
|
2-state checkbox item.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.Is3State()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItem3StateValue(self, item, state):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the checkbox item to the given `state`.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `state`: can be one of: ``wx.CHK_UNCHECKED`` (check is off), ``wx.CHK_CHECKED``
|
|
(check is on) or ``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED`` (check is mixed).
|
|
|
|
:note: This method raises an exception when the checkbox item is a 2-state checkbox
|
|
and setting the state to ``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED``.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.Set3StateValue(state)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItem3State(self, item, allow):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether the item has a 3-state value checkbox assigned to it or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `allow`: ``True`` to set an item as a 3-state checkbox, ``False`` to set it
|
|
to a 2-state checkbox.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the change was successful, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.Set3State(allow)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CheckItem2(self, item, checked=True, torefresh=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Used internally to avoid ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED`` events.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it;
|
|
:param bool `torefresh`: whether to redraw the item or not.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.GetType() == 0:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
item.Check(checked)
|
|
|
|
if torefresh:
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self.CalculateSize(item, dc)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def UnCheckRadioParent(self, item, checked=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Used internally to handle radio node parent correctly.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
e = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING, self.GetId())
|
|
e.SetItem(item)
|
|
e.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(e):
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
item.Check(checked)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
self.EnableChildren(item, checked)
|
|
e = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED, self.GetId())
|
|
e.SetItem(item)
|
|
e.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(e)
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CheckItem(self, item, checked=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Actually checks/uncheks an item, sending (eventually) the two
|
|
events ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING`` and ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED``.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: for a radiobutton-type item, ``True`` to check it, ``False``
|
|
to uncheck it. For a checkbox-type item, it can be one of ``wx.CHK_UNCHECKED``
|
|
when the checkbox is unchecked, ``wx.CHK_CHECKED`` when it is checked and
|
|
``wx.CHK_UNDETERMINED`` when it's in the undetermined state.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Should we raise an error here?!?
|
|
if item.GetType() == 0:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if item.GetType() == 2: # it's a radio button
|
|
if not checked and item.IsChecked(): # Try To Unckeck?
|
|
return
|
|
else:
|
|
if not self.UnCheckRadioParent(item, checked):
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
self.CheckSameLevel(item, False)
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
# Radiobuttons are done, let's handle checkbuttons...
|
|
e = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING, self.GetId())
|
|
e.SetItem(item)
|
|
e.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(e):
|
|
# Blocked by user
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if item.Is3State():
|
|
item.Set3StateValue(checked)
|
|
else:
|
|
item.Check(checked)
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_AUTO_CHECK_CHILD):
|
|
ischeck = self.IsItemChecked(item)
|
|
self.AutoCheckChild(item, ischeck)
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_AUTO_CHECK_PARENT):
|
|
ischeck = self.IsItemChecked(item)
|
|
self.AutoCheckParent(item, ischeck)
|
|
elif self.HasAGWFlag(TR_AUTO_TOGGLE_CHILD):
|
|
self.AutoToggleChild(item)
|
|
|
|
e = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED, self.GetId())
|
|
e.SetItem(item)
|
|
e.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(e)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AutoToggleChild(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Transverses the tree and toggles the items.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(item)
|
|
|
|
torefresh = False
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
torefresh = True
|
|
|
|
# Recurse on tree
|
|
while child:
|
|
if child.GetType() == 1 and child.IsEnabled():
|
|
self.CheckItem2(child, not child.IsChecked(), torefresh=torefresh)
|
|
self.AutoToggleChild(child)
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AutoCheckChild(self, item, checked):
|
|
"""
|
|
Transverses the tree and checks/unchecks the items.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetFirstChild(item)
|
|
|
|
torefresh = False
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
torefresh = True
|
|
|
|
while child:
|
|
if child.GetType() == 1 and child.IsEnabled():
|
|
self.CheckItem2(child, checked, torefresh=torefresh)
|
|
self.AutoCheckChild(child, checked)
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AutoCheckParent(self, item, checked):
|
|
"""
|
|
Traverses up the tree and checks/unchecks parent items.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
parent = item.GetParent()
|
|
if not parent or parent.GetType() != 1:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetFirstChild(parent)
|
|
while child:
|
|
if child.GetType() == 1 and child.IsEnabled():
|
|
if checked != child.IsChecked():
|
|
return
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetNextChild(parent, cookie)
|
|
|
|
self.CheckItem2(parent, checked, torefresh=True)
|
|
self.AutoCheckParent(parent, checked)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CheckChilds(self, item, checked=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Programatically check/uncheck item children.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for checkbox-like and radiobutton-like items.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method does not generate ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKING`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_CHECKED`` events.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if checked == None:
|
|
self.AutoToggleChild(item)
|
|
else:
|
|
self.AutoCheckChild(item, checked)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CheckSameLevel(self, item, checked=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Uncheck radio items which are on the same level of the checked one.
|
|
Used internally.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `checked`: ``True`` to check an item, ``False`` to uncheck it.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for radiobutton-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
parent = item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
if not parent:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
torefresh = False
|
|
if parent.IsExpanded():
|
|
torefresh = True
|
|
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetFirstChild(parent)
|
|
while child:
|
|
if child.GetType() == 2 and child != item:
|
|
self.CheckItem2(child, checked, torefresh=torefresh)
|
|
if child.GetType != 2 or (child.GetType() == 2 and child.IsChecked()):
|
|
self.EnableChildren(child, checked)
|
|
(child, cookie) = self.GetNextChild(parent, cookie)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def EditLabel(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Starts editing an item label.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.Edit(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ShouldInheritColours(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Return ``True`` from here to allow the colours of this window to be
|
|
changed by `InheritAttributes`, returning ``False`` forbids inheriting them
|
|
from the parent window.
|
|
|
|
The base class version returns ``False``, but this method is overridden in
|
|
:class:`Control` where it returns ``True``.
|
|
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl` does not inherit colours from anyone.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetIndent(self, indent):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the indentation for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `indent`: an integer representing the indentation for the items in the tree.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._indent = indent
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetSpacing(self, spacing):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the spacing between items in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `spacing`: an integer representing the spacing between items in the tree.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._spacing = spacing
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether an item has children or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return len(item.GetChildren()) > 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetChildrenCount(self, item, recursively=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item children count.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `recursively`: if ``True``, returns the total number of descendants,
|
|
otherwise only one level of children is counted.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetChildrenCount(recursively)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasAGWFlag(self, flag):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns ``True`` if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the `flag` bit set.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `flag`: any possible window style for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:see: The :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.__init__` method for the `flag` parameter description.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._agwStyle & flag
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetAGWWindowStyleFlag(self, agwStyle):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` window style.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `agwStyle`: the new :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` window style.
|
|
|
|
:see: The :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.__init__` method for the `agwStyle` parameter description.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Do not try to expand the root node if it hasn't been created yet
|
|
if self._anchor and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT) and agwStyle & TR_HIDE_ROOT:
|
|
|
|
# if we will hide the root, make sure children are visible
|
|
self._anchor.SetHasPlus()
|
|
self._anchor.Expand()
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
|
|
# right now, just sets the styles. Eventually, we may
|
|
# want to update the inherited styles, but right now
|
|
# none of the parents has updatable styles
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE) and not (agwStyle & TR_MULTIPLE):
|
|
selections = self.GetSelections()
|
|
for select in selections[0:-1]:
|
|
self.SelectItem(select, False)
|
|
|
|
self._agwStyle = agwStyle
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetAGWWindowStyleFlag(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` style.
|
|
|
|
:see: The :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.__init__` method for a list of possible style flags.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._agwStyle
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HasButtons(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_HAS_BUTTONS`` flag set.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_HAS_BUTTONS`` flag set,
|
|
``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HAS_BUTTONS)
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# functions to work with tree items
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def GetItemText(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item text.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetText()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemSize(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the horizontal space available in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`, in pixels, to draw this item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
.. versionadded:: 0.9.3
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
w, h = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
xa, ya = self.CalcScrolledPosition((0, item.GetY()))
|
|
|
|
wcheck = image_w = 0
|
|
|
|
if item.GetType() != 0:
|
|
wcheck, dummy = self._imageListCheck.GetSize(item.GetType())
|
|
wcheck += 4
|
|
|
|
image = item.GetCurrentImage()
|
|
|
|
if image != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
if self._imageListNormal:
|
|
image_w, dummy = self._imageListNormal.GetSize(image)
|
|
image_w += 4
|
|
|
|
maxsize = w - (wcheck + image_w + item.GetX()) + xa
|
|
return maxsize
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemImage(self, item, which=TreeItemIcon_Normal):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item image.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `which`: can be one of the following bits:
|
|
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
Item State Description
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Normal`` To get the normal item image
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Selected`` To get the selected item image (i.e. the image which is shown when the item is currently selected)
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_Expanded`` To get the expanded image (this only makes sense for items which have children - then this image is shown when the item is expanded and the normal image is shown when it is collapsed)
|
|
``TreeItemIcon_SelectedExpanded`` To get the selected expanded image (which is shown when an expanded item is currently selected)
|
|
================================= ========================
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetImage(which)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemLeftImage(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item leftmost image, i.e. the image associated to the item on the leftmost
|
|
part of the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` client area.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer index that can be used to retrieve the item leftmost image inside
|
|
a :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetLeftImage()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetPyData(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the data associated to an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: A Python object representing the item data, or ``None`` if no data
|
|
has been assigned to this item.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetData()
|
|
|
|
GetItemPyData = GetPyData
|
|
GetItemData = GetPyData
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemTextColour(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item text colour or separator horizontal line colour.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.Attr().GetTextColour()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemBackgroundColour(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item background colour.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.Attr().GetBackgroundColour()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemFont(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item font.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Font`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
font = item.Attr().GetFont()
|
|
if font.IsOk():
|
|
return font
|
|
|
|
return wx.NullFont
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItemHyperText(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether an item is hypertext or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is hypertext-like, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsHyperText()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemText(self, item, text):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item text.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param string `text`: the new item label.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if the input `item` is a separator.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSeparator():
|
|
raise Exception("Separator items can not have text")
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
item.SetText(text)
|
|
self.CalculateSize(item, dc)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemImage(self, item, image, which=TreeItemIcon_Normal):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item image, depending on the item state.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in the state specified by the `which` parameter;
|
|
:param integer `which`: the item state.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.GetItemImage` for an explanation of the `which` parameter.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetImage(image, which)
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self.CalculateSize(item, dc)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemLeftImage(self, item, image):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item leftmost image, i.e. the image associated to the item on the leftmost
|
|
part of the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` client area.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the left image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in the leftmost part of the client area.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetLeftImage(image)
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self.CalculateSize(item, dc)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetPyData(self, item, data):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the data associated to an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param object `data`: can be any Python object.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetData(data)
|
|
|
|
SetItemPyData = SetPyData
|
|
SetItemData = SetPyData
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemHasChildren(self, item, has=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Forces the appearance/disappearance of the button next to the item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `has`: ``True`` to have a button next to an item, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetHasPlus(has)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemBold(self, item, bold=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item font as bold/unbold.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `bold`: ``True`` to set the item font as bold, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# avoid redrawing the tree if no real change
|
|
if item.IsBold() != bold:
|
|
item.SetBold(bold)
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemItalic(self, item, italic=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item font as italic/non-italic.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `italic`: ``True`` to set the item font as italic, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsItalic() != italic:
|
|
item.SetItalic(italic)
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemDropHighlight(self, item, highlight=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gives the item the visual feedback for drag and drop operations.
|
|
This is useful when something is dragged from outside the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `highlight`: ``True`` to highlight the dragged items, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if highlight:
|
|
bg = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT)
|
|
fg = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT)
|
|
|
|
item.Attr().SetTextColour(fg)
|
|
item.Attr.SetBackgroundColour(bg)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemTextColour(self, item, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item text colour or separator horizontal line colour.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.Attr().SetTextColour(colour)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemBackgroundColour(self, item, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item background colour.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.Attr().SetBackgroundColour(colour)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemHyperText(self, item, hyper=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether the item is hypertext or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `hyper`: ``True`` to have an item with hypertext behaviour, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetHyperText(hyper)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemFont(self, item, font):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item font.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `font`: a valid :class:`Font` instance.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.Attr().SetFont(font)
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetFont(self, font):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` font.
|
|
|
|
:param `font`: a valid :class:`Font` instance.
|
|
|
|
:note: Overridden from :class:`ScrolledWindow`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
wx.ScrolledWindow.SetFont(self, font)
|
|
|
|
self._normalFont = font
|
|
family = self._normalFont.GetFamily()
|
|
|
|
if family == wx.FONTFAMILY_UNKNOWN:
|
|
family = wx.FONTFAMILY_SWISS
|
|
|
|
self._boldFont = wx.Font(self._normalFont.GetPointSize(), family,
|
|
self._normalFont.GetStyle(), wx.FONTWEIGHT_BOLD, self._normalFont.GetUnderlined(),
|
|
self._normalFont.GetFaceName(), self._normalFont.GetEncoding())
|
|
|
|
self._italicFont = wx.Font(self._normalFont.GetPointSize(), family,
|
|
wx.FONTSTYLE_ITALIC, wx.FONTWEIGHT_NORMAL, self._normalFont.GetUnderlined(),
|
|
self._normalFont.GetFaceName(), self._normalFont.GetEncoding())
|
|
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
self.AdjustMyScrollbars()
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetHyperTextFont(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the font used to render hypertext items.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Font`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hypertextfont
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHyperTextFont(self, font):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the font used to render hypertext items.
|
|
|
|
:param `font`: a valid :class:`Font` instance.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hypertextfont = font
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHyperTextNewColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the colour used to render a non-visited hypertext item.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hypertextnewcolour = colour
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetHyperTextNewColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the colour used to render a non-visited hypertext item.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hypertextnewcolour
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHyperTextVisitedColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the colour used to render a visited hypertext item.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hypertextvisitedcolour = colour
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetHyperTextVisitedColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the colour used to render a visited hypertext item.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hypertextvisitedcolour
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemVisited(self, item, visited=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets whether an hypertext item was visited.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `visited`: ``True`` to mark an hypertext item as visited, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetVisited(visited)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemVisited(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether an hypertext item was visited.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the hypertext item has been visited, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is meaningful only for hypertext-like items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetVisited()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHilightFocusColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the colour used to highlight focused selected items.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is applied only if gradient and Windows Vista selection
|
|
styles are disabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hilightBrush = wx.Brush(colour)
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetHilightNonFocusColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the colour used to highlight unfocused selected items.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid :class:`Colour` instance.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is applied only if gradient and Windows Vista selection
|
|
styles are disabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hilightUnfocusedBrush = wx.Brush(colour)
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetHilightFocusColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the colour used to highlight focused selected items.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is used only if gradient and Windows Vista selection
|
|
styles are disabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hilightBrush.GetColour()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetHilightNonFocusColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the colour used to highlight unfocused selected items.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This is used only if gradient and Windows Vista selection
|
|
styles are disabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._hilightUnfocusedBrush.GetColour()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetFirstGradientColour(self, colour=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the first gradient colour for gradient-style selections.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: if not ``None``, a valid :class:`Colour` instance. Otherwise,
|
|
the colour is taken from the system value ``wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT``.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if colour is None:
|
|
colour = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT)
|
|
|
|
self._firstcolour = colour
|
|
if self._usegradients:
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetSecondGradientColour(self, colour=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the second gradient colour for gradient-style selections.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: if not ``None``, a valid :class:`Colour` instance. Otherwise,
|
|
the colour generated is a slightly darker version of the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`
|
|
background colour.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if colour is None:
|
|
# No colour given, generate a slightly darker from the
|
|
# CustomTreeCtrl background colour
|
|
colour = self.GetBackgroundColour()
|
|
r, g, b = int(colour.Red()), int(colour.Green()), int(colour.Blue())
|
|
colour = ((r >> 1) + 20, (g >> 1) + 20, (b >> 1) + 20)
|
|
colour = wx.Colour(colour[0], colour[1], colour[2])
|
|
|
|
self._secondcolour = colour
|
|
|
|
if self._usegradients:
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetFirstGradientColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the first gradient colour for gradient-style selections.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._firstcolour
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetSecondGradientColour(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the second gradient colour for gradient-style selections.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._secondcolour
|
|
|
|
|
|
def EnableSelectionGradient(self, enable=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Globally enables/disables drawing of gradient selections.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable gradient-style selections, ``False``
|
|
to disable it.
|
|
|
|
:note: Calling this method disables any Vista-style selection previously
|
|
enabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._usegradients = enable
|
|
self._vistaselection = False
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetGradientStyle(self, vertical=0):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the gradient style for gradient-style selections.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `vertical`: ``0`` for horizontal gradient-style selections, ``1`` for vertical
|
|
gradient-style selections.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# 0 = Horizontal, 1 = Vertical
|
|
self._gradientstyle = vertical
|
|
|
|
if self._usegradients:
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetGradientStyle(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the gradient style for gradient-style selections.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``0`` for horizontal gradient-style selections, ``1`` for vertical
|
|
gradient-style selections.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._gradientstyle
|
|
|
|
|
|
def EnableSelectionVista(self, enable=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Globally enables/disables drawing of Windows Vista selections.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable Vista-style selections, ``False`` to
|
|
disable it.
|
|
|
|
:note: Calling this method disables any gradient-style selection previously
|
|
enabled.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._usegradients = False
|
|
self._vistaselection = enable
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetBorderPen(self, pen):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the pen used to draw the selected item border.
|
|
|
|
:param `pen`: an instance of :class:`Pen`.
|
|
|
|
:note: The border pen is not used if the Windows Vista selection style is applied.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._borderPen = pen
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetBorderPen(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the pen used to draw the selected item border.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Pen`.
|
|
|
|
:note: The border pen is not used if the Windows Vista selection style is applied.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._borderPen
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetConnectionPen(self, pen):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the pen used to draw the connecting lines between items.
|
|
|
|
:param `pen`: an instance of :class:`Pen`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._dottedPen = pen
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetConnectionPen(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the pen used to draw the connecting lines between items.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Pen`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._dottedPen
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetBackgroundImage(self, image):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` background image.
|
|
|
|
:param `image`: if not ``None``, an instance of :class:`Bitmap`.
|
|
|
|
:note: At present, the background image can only be used in "tile" mode.
|
|
|
|
.. todo:: Support background images also in stretch and centered modes.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._backgroundImage = image
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetBackgroundImage(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` background image (if any).
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Bitmap` if a background image is present, ``None`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: At present, the background image can only be used in "tile" mode.
|
|
|
|
.. todo:: Support background images also in stretch and centered modes.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._backgroundImage
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetSeparatorColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the pen colour for separator-type items.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: a valid instance of :class:`Colour`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._separatorPen = wx.Pen(colour, 1)
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetSeparatorColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the pen colour for separator-type items.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Colour` representing the separator pen colour.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._separatorPen.GetColour()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItemSeparator(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether an item is of separator type or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsSeparator()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemWindow(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the window associated to the item (if any).
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Window` if the item has an associated window, ``None`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetWindow()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemWindow(self, item, wnd):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the window for the given item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to be displayed next to
|
|
the item.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if the input `item` is a separator and `wnd` is not ``None``.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSeparator() and wnd is not None:
|
|
raise Exception("Separator items can not have an associated window")
|
|
|
|
if wnd is not None:
|
|
self._hasWindows = True
|
|
if item not in self._itemWithWindow:
|
|
self._itemWithWindow.append(item)
|
|
else:
|
|
self.DeleteItemWindow(item)
|
|
else:
|
|
self.DeleteItemWindow(item)
|
|
|
|
item.SetWindow(wnd)
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
self.AdjustMyScrollbars()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DeleteItemWindow(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Deletes the window associated to an item (if any).
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.GetWindow() is None:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
item.DeleteWindow()
|
|
if item in self._itemWithWindow:
|
|
self._itemWithWindow.remove(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemWindowEnabled(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the window associated to the item is enabled.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has an associated window and this window is
|
|
enabled, ``False`` in all other cases.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetWindowEnabled()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemWindowEnabled(self, item, enable=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Enables/disables the window associated to the item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `enable`: ``True`` to enable the associated window, ``False`` to
|
|
disable it.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetWindowEnabled(enable)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetItemType(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item type.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An integer representing the item type.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a description of valid item types.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetType()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetItemType(self, item, ct_type):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the item type.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: may be one of the following integers:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`ct_type` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 A normal item
|
|
1 A checkbox-like item
|
|
2 A radiobutton-type item
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
|
|
:note: Regarding radiobutton-type items (with `ct_type` = 2), the following
|
|
approach is used:
|
|
|
|
- All peer-nodes that are radiobuttons will be mutually exclusive. In other words,
|
|
only one of a set of radiobuttons that share a common parent can be checked at
|
|
once. If a radiobutton node becomes checked, then all of its peer radiobuttons
|
|
must be unchecked.
|
|
- If a radiobutton node becomes unchecked, then all of its child nodes will become
|
|
inactive.
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
item.SetType(ct_type)
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# item status inquiries
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def IsVisible(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is visible or not (i.e., its hierarchy is expanded
|
|
enough to show the item).
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is visible, ``False`` if it is hidden.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# An item is only visible if it's not a descendant of a collapsed item
|
|
parent = item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
while parent:
|
|
|
|
if not parent.IsExpanded():
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
parent = parent.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
startX, startY = self.GetViewStart()
|
|
clientSize = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
|
|
rect = self.GetBoundingRect(item)
|
|
|
|
if not rect:
|
|
return False
|
|
if rect.GetWidth() == 0 or rect.GetHeight() == 0:
|
|
return False
|
|
if rect.GetBottom() < 0 or rect.GetTop() > clientSize.y:
|
|
return False
|
|
if rect.GetRight() < 0 or rect.GetLeft() > clientSize.x:
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ItemHasChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item has children or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has children, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# consider that the item does have children if it has the "+" button: it
|
|
# might not have them (if it had never been expanded yet) but then it
|
|
# could have them as well and it's better to err on this side rather than
|
|
# disabling some operations which are restricted to the items with
|
|
# children for an item which does have them
|
|
return item.HasPlus()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsExpanded(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is expanded or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is expanded, ``False`` if it is collapsed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsExpanded()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsSelected(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item is selected or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item is selected, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsSelected()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsBold(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item font is bold or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has bold text, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsBold()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsItalic(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether the item font is italic or not.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the item has italic text, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.IsItalic()
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# navigation
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def GetItemParent(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item parent (can be ``None`` for root items).
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` for root items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetFirstChild(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item's first child and an integer value 'cookie'.
|
|
Call :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.GetNextChild` for the next child using this very 'cookie' return
|
|
value as an input.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: A tuple with the first value being an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
further children, and as second value an integer parameter 'cookie'.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method returns ``None`` if there are no further children.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
cookie = 0
|
|
return self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNextChild(self, item, cookie):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item's next child.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `cookie`: a parameter which is opaque for the application but is necessary
|
|
for the library to make these functions reentrant (i.e. allow more than one
|
|
enumeration on one and the same object simultaneously).
|
|
|
|
:return: A tuple with the first value being an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
further children, and as second value an integer parameter 'cookie'.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method returns ``None`` if there are no further children.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
|
|
# it's ok to cast cookie to size_t, we never have indices big enough to
|
|
# overflow "void *"
|
|
|
|
if cookie < len(children):
|
|
|
|
return children[cookie], cookie+1
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
# there are no more of them
|
|
return None, cookie
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetLastChild(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the item last child.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
further children.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
return (len(children) == 0 and [None] or [children[-1]])[0]
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNextSibling(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the next sibling of an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
further siblings.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method returns ``None`` if there are no further siblings.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
i = item
|
|
parent = i.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
if parent == None:
|
|
|
|
# root item doesn't have any siblings
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
siblings = parent.GetChildren()
|
|
index = siblings.index(i)
|
|
|
|
n = index + 1
|
|
return (n == len(siblings) and [None] or [siblings[n]])[0]
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetPrevSibling(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the previous sibling of an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
further siblings.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method returns ``None`` if there are no further siblings.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
i = item
|
|
parent = i.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
if parent == None:
|
|
|
|
# root item doesn't have any siblings
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
siblings = parent.GetChildren()
|
|
index = siblings.index(i)
|
|
|
|
return (index == 0 and [None] or [siblings[index-1]])[0]
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNext(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the next item. Only for internal use right now.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
further items.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
i = item
|
|
|
|
# First see if there are any children.
|
|
children = i.GetChildren()
|
|
if len(children) > 0:
|
|
return children[0]
|
|
else:
|
|
# Try a sibling of this or ancestor instead
|
|
p = item
|
|
toFind = None
|
|
while p and not toFind:
|
|
toFind = self.GetNextSibling(p)
|
|
p = self.GetItemParent(p)
|
|
|
|
return toFind
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetPrev(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the previous item. Only for internal use right now.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Look for a previous sibling of this item
|
|
prevSibling = self.GetPrevSibling(item)
|
|
if prevSibling:
|
|
|
|
# return it's last child or itself if has not got any children
|
|
if len(prevSibling.GetChildren()) > 0:
|
|
return self.GetLastChild(prevSibling)
|
|
|
|
return prevSibling
|
|
|
|
# item has not got a previous sibling, return it's parent
|
|
return self.GetItemParent(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNextExpanded(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the next expanded item after the input one.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`TreeListItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
nextSibling = self.GetNextSibling(item)
|
|
if nextSibling:
|
|
if nextSibling.IsExpanded():
|
|
return nextSibling
|
|
|
|
return self.GetNextExpanded(prevSibling)
|
|
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetPrevExpanded(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the previous expanded item before the input one.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`TreeListItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
prevSibling = self.GetPrevSibling(item)
|
|
if prevSibling:
|
|
if prevSibling.IsExpanded():
|
|
return prevSibling
|
|
|
|
return self.GetPrevExpanded(prevSibling)
|
|
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetFirstVisibleItem(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the first visible item.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
visible items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
id = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
if not id:
|
|
return id
|
|
|
|
while id:
|
|
if self.IsVisible(id):
|
|
return id
|
|
id = self.GetNext(id)
|
|
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNextVisible(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the next visible item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
next visible items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
id = item
|
|
|
|
while id:
|
|
id = self.GetNext(id)
|
|
if id and self.IsVisible(id):
|
|
return id
|
|
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetPrevVisible(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the previous visible item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if there are no
|
|
previous visible items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# find a previous sibling or parent which is visible
|
|
lastGoodItem = self.GetPrevSibling(item)
|
|
if not lastGoodItem or not self.IsVisible(lastGoodItem):
|
|
parent = self.GetItemParent(item)
|
|
rootHidden = self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT)
|
|
rootItem = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
|
|
while parent and not (rootHidden and parent == rootItem):
|
|
if self.IsVisible(parent):
|
|
lastGoodItem = parent
|
|
break
|
|
parent = self.GetItemParent(parent)
|
|
|
|
if not lastGoodItem:
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
# test if found item has visible children, if so and if the found item is not the
|
|
# parent of the current item traverse the found item to the last visible child
|
|
if not self.HasChildren(lastGoodItem) or not self.IsExpanded(lastGoodItem) or \
|
|
(self.GetItemParent(item) == lastGoodItem):
|
|
return lastGoodItem
|
|
|
|
lastChild = self.GetLastChild(lastGoodItem)
|
|
while lastChild and self.IsVisible(lastChild):
|
|
lastGoodItem = lastChild
|
|
lastChild = self.GetLastChild(lastGoodItem)
|
|
|
|
return lastGoodItem
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ResetEditControl(self):
|
|
""" Called by :class:`TreeTextCtrl` when it marks itself for deletion. """
|
|
|
|
if self._editCtrl is not None:
|
|
self._editCtrl.Destroy()
|
|
self._editCtrl = None
|
|
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
self.AdjustMyScrollbars()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def FindItem(self, idParent, prefixOrig):
|
|
"""
|
|
Finds the first item starting with the given prefix after the given parent.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `idParent`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param string `prefixOrig`: a string containing the item text prefix.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if no item has been found.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# match is case insensitive as this is more convenient to the user: having
|
|
# to press Shift-letter to go to the item starting with a capital letter
|
|
# would be too bothersome
|
|
prefix = prefixOrig.lower()
|
|
|
|
# determine the starting point: we shouldn't take the current item (this
|
|
# allows to switch between two items starting with the same letter just by
|
|
# pressing it) but we shouldn't jump to the next one if the user is
|
|
# continuing to type as otherwise he might easily skip the item he wanted
|
|
id = idParent
|
|
|
|
if len(prefix) == 1:
|
|
id = self.GetNext(id)
|
|
|
|
# look for the item starting with the given prefix after it
|
|
while id and not self.GetItemText(id).lower().startswith(prefix):
|
|
|
|
id = self.GetNext(id)
|
|
|
|
# if we haven't found anything...
|
|
if not id:
|
|
|
|
# ... wrap to the beginning
|
|
id = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
# can't select virtual root
|
|
id = self.GetNext(id)
|
|
if idParent == self.GetRootItem():
|
|
# no tree item selected and idParent is not reachable
|
|
return id
|
|
|
|
# and try all the items (stop when we get to the one we started from)
|
|
while id != idParent and not self.GetItemText(id).lower().startswith(prefix):
|
|
id = self.GetNext(id)
|
|
|
|
return id
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# operations
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def DoInsertItem(self, parentId, previous, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None, separator=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Actually inserts an item in the tree.
|
|
|
|
:param `parentId`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
item's parent;
|
|
:param integer `previous`: the index at which we should insert the item;
|
|
:param string `text`: the item text label;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the item type (see :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a list of valid
|
|
item types);
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to show next to the item, any
|
|
subclass of :class:`Window` except top-level windows;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item;
|
|
:param bool `separator`: ``True`` if the item is a separator, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` in the following cases:
|
|
|
|
- The item window is not ``None`` but the ``TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT`` flag has not been
|
|
set for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`;
|
|
- The item has multiline text (with line-breaks in it) but the ``TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT``
|
|
flag has not been set for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`;
|
|
- The `ct_type` attribute is less than ``0`` or greater than ``2``;
|
|
- The parent item is a separator;
|
|
- The item is a separator but it has text or an associated window.
|
|
|
|
|
|
:note: Separator items should not have children, text labels or an associated window.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if wnd is not None and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT):
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: In Order To Append/Insert Controls You Have To Use The Style TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT")
|
|
|
|
if text.find("\n") >= 0 and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT):
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: In Order To Append/Insert A MultiLine Text You Have To Use The Style TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT")
|
|
|
|
if ct_type < 0 or ct_type > 2:
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: Item Type Should Be 0 (Normal), 1 (CheckBox) or 2 (RadioButton). ")
|
|
|
|
if separator:
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
raise Exception("Separator items can not have associated windows")
|
|
if text.strip():
|
|
raise Exception("Separator items can not text labels")
|
|
|
|
parent = parentId
|
|
|
|
if not parent:
|
|
# should we give a warning here?
|
|
return self.AddRoot(text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data)
|
|
|
|
self._dirty = True # do this first so stuff below doesn't cause flicker
|
|
|
|
item = GenericTreeItem(parent, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data, separator)
|
|
|
|
if wnd is not None:
|
|
self._hasWindows = True
|
|
self._itemWithWindow.append(item)
|
|
|
|
parent.Insert(item, previous)
|
|
|
|
return item
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AddRoot(self, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Adds a root item to the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param string `text`: the item text label;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the item type (see :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a list of valid
|
|
item types);
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to show next to the item,
|
|
any subclass of :class:`Window` except top-level windows;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` in the following cases:
|
|
|
|
- There already is a root item in the tree;
|
|
- The item window is not ``None`` but the ``TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT`` flag has not been
|
|
set for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`;
|
|
- The item has multiline text (with line-breaks in it) but the ``TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT``
|
|
flag has not been set for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`;
|
|
- The `ct_type` attribute is less than ``0`` or greater than ``2``.
|
|
|
|
.. warning::
|
|
|
|
Only one root is allowed to exist in any given instance of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._anchor:
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: Tree Can Have Only One Root")
|
|
|
|
if wnd is not None and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT):
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: In Order To Append/Insert Controls You Have To Use The Style TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT")
|
|
|
|
if text.find("\n") >= 0 and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT):
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: In Order To Append/Insert A MultiLine Text You Have To Use The Style TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT")
|
|
|
|
if ct_type < 0 or ct_type > 2:
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: Item Type Should Be 0 (Normal), 1 (CheckBox) or 2 (RadioButton). ")
|
|
|
|
self._dirty = True # do this first so stuff below doesn't cause flicker
|
|
|
|
self._anchor = GenericTreeItem(None, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data)
|
|
|
|
if wnd is not None:
|
|
self._hasWindows = True
|
|
self._itemWithWindow.append(self._anchor)
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
|
|
# if root is hidden, make sure we can navigate
|
|
# into children
|
|
self._anchor.SetHasPlus()
|
|
self._anchor.Expand()
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE):
|
|
|
|
self._current = self._key_current = self._anchor
|
|
self._current.SetHilight(True)
|
|
|
|
return self._anchor
|
|
|
|
|
|
def PrependItem(self, parent, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None, separator=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Prepends an item as a first child of parent.
|
|
|
|
:param `parent`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
item's parent;
|
|
:param string `text`: the item text label;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the item type (see :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a list of valid
|
|
item types);
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to show next to the item, any
|
|
subclass of :class:`Window` except top-level windows;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item;
|
|
:param bool `separator`: ``True`` if the item is a separator, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.DoInsertItem(parent, 0, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data, separator)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def InsertItemByItem(self, parentId, idPrevious, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None, separator=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Inserts an item after the given previous.
|
|
|
|
:param `parentId`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
item's parent;
|
|
:param `idPrevious`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
previous item;
|
|
:param string `text`: the item text label;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the item type (see :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a list of valid
|
|
item types);
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to show next to the item,
|
|
any subclass of :class:`Window`;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item;
|
|
:param bool `separator`: ``True`` if the item is a separator, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if the previous item is not a sibling.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for other possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
parent = parentId
|
|
|
|
if not parent:
|
|
# should we give a warning here?
|
|
return self.AddRoot(text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data)
|
|
|
|
index = -1
|
|
if idPrevious:
|
|
|
|
try:
|
|
index = parent.GetChildren().index(idPrevious)
|
|
except:
|
|
raise Exception("ERROR: Previous Item In CustomTreeCtrl.InsertItem() Is Not A Sibling")
|
|
|
|
return self.DoInsertItem(parentId, index+1, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data, separator)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def InsertItemByIndex(self, parentId, idPrevious, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None, separator=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Inserts an item after the given previous.
|
|
|
|
:param `parentId`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
item's parent;
|
|
:param `idPrevious`: the index at which we should insert the new item;
|
|
:param string `text`: the item text label;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the item type (see :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a list of valid
|
|
item types);
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to show next to the item,
|
|
any subclass of :class:`Window`;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item;
|
|
:param bool `separator`: ``True`` if the item is a separator, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
parent = parentId
|
|
|
|
if not parent:
|
|
# should we give a warning here?
|
|
return self.AddRoot(text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data)
|
|
|
|
return self.DoInsertItem(parentId, idPrevious, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data, separator)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def InsertItem(self, parentId, input, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None, separator=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Inserts an item after the given previous.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.InsertItemByIndex` and :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.InsertItemByItem` for an explanation of
|
|
the input parameters.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if type(input) == type(1):
|
|
return self.InsertItemByIndex(parentId, input, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data, separator)
|
|
else:
|
|
return self.InsertItemByItem(parentId, input, text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data, separator)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AppendItem(self, parentId, text, ct_type=0, wnd=None, image=-1, selImage=-1, data=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Appends an item as a last child of its parent.
|
|
|
|
:param `parentId`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
item's parent;
|
|
:param string `text`: the item text label;
|
|
:param integer `ct_type`: the item type (see :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.SetItemType` for a list of valid
|
|
item types);
|
|
:param `wnd`: if not ``None``, a non-toplevel window to show next to the item,
|
|
any subclass of :class:`Window`;
|
|
:param integer `image`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in unselected state;
|
|
:param integer `selImage`: an index within the normal image list specifying the image to
|
|
use for the item in selected state; if `image` > -1 and `selImage` is -1, the
|
|
same image is used for both selected and unselected items;
|
|
:param object `data`: associate the given Python object `data` with the item.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
parent = parentId
|
|
|
|
if not parent:
|
|
# should we give a warning here?
|
|
return self.AddRoot(text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data)
|
|
|
|
return self.DoInsertItem(parent, len(parent.GetChildren()), text, ct_type, wnd, image, selImage, data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AppendSeparator(self, parentId):
|
|
"""
|
|
Appends an horizontal line separator as a last child of its parent.
|
|
|
|
:param `parentId`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
separator's parent.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
parent = parentId
|
|
return self.DoInsertItem(parent, len(parent.GetChildren()), "", separator=True)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def InsertSeparator(self, parentId, input):
|
|
"""
|
|
Inserts a separator item after the given previous.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.InsertItemByIndex` and :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.InsertItemByItem` for an explanation of
|
|
the input parameters.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.InsertItem(parentId, input, "", separator=True)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def PrependSeparator(self, parent):
|
|
"""
|
|
Prepends a separator item as a first child of parent.
|
|
|
|
:param `parent`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` representing the
|
|
item's parent.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` upon successful insertion.
|
|
|
|
:see: :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.DoInsertItem` for possible exceptions generated by this method.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self.PrependItem(parent, 0, separator=True)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SendDeleteEvent(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Actually sends the ``EVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM`` event.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = item
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def IsDescendantOf(self, parent, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Checks if the given item is under another one in the tree hierarchy.
|
|
|
|
:param `parent`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`, representing the possible
|
|
parent of `item`;
|
|
:param `item`: another instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if `item` is a descendant of `parent`, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
while item:
|
|
|
|
if item == parent:
|
|
|
|
# item is a descendant of parent
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
item = item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
|
|
# Don't leave edit or selection on a child which is about to disappear
|
|
def ChildrenClosing(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
We are about to destroy the item children.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and item != self._editCtrl.item() and self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._editCtrl.item()):
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
|
|
if item != self._key_current and self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._key_current):
|
|
self._key_current = None
|
|
|
|
if self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._select_me):
|
|
self._select_me = item
|
|
|
|
if item != self._current and self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._current):
|
|
self._current.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self._current = None
|
|
self._select_me = item
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DeleteChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Delete all the item's children.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._dirty = True # do this first so stuff below doesn't cause flicker
|
|
|
|
self.ChildrenClosing(item)
|
|
item.DeleteChildren(self)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Delete(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Deletes an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method sends the ``EVT_TREE_DELETE_ITEM`` event.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._dirty = True # do this first so stuff below doesn't cause flicker
|
|
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._editCtrl.item()):
|
|
# can't delete the item being edited, cancel editing it first
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
|
|
parent = item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
# don't keep stale pointers around!
|
|
if self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._key_current):
|
|
|
|
# Don't silently change the selection:
|
|
# do it properly in idle time, so event
|
|
# handlers get called.
|
|
|
|
# self._key_current = parent
|
|
self._key_current = None
|
|
|
|
# self._select_me records whether we need to select
|
|
# a different item, in idle time.
|
|
if self._select_me and self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._select_me):
|
|
self._select_me = parent
|
|
|
|
if self.IsDescendantOf(item, self._current):
|
|
|
|
# Don't silently change the selection:
|
|
# do it properly in idle time, so event
|
|
# handlers get called.
|
|
|
|
# self._current = parent
|
|
self._current = None
|
|
self._select_me = parent
|
|
|
|
# remove the item from the tree
|
|
if parent:
|
|
|
|
parent.GetChildren().remove(item) # remove by value
|
|
|
|
else: # deleting the root
|
|
|
|
# nothing will be left in the tree
|
|
self._anchor = None
|
|
|
|
# and delete all of its children and the item itself now
|
|
item.DeleteChildren(self)
|
|
self.SendDeleteEvent(item)
|
|
|
|
if item == self._select_me:
|
|
self._select_me = None
|
|
|
|
# Remove the item with window
|
|
if item in self._itemWithWindow:
|
|
wnd = item.GetWindow()
|
|
wnd.Hide()
|
|
wnd.Destroy()
|
|
item._wnd = None
|
|
self._itemWithWindow.remove(item)
|
|
|
|
del item
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DeleteAllItems(self):
|
|
""" Deletes all items in the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`. """
|
|
|
|
if self._anchor:
|
|
self.Delete(self._anchor)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Expand(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Expands an item, sending a ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED`` events.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if you try to expand a hidden root (i.e., when the ``TR_HIDE_ROOT``
|
|
style is set for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT) and item == self.GetRootItem():
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: Can't Expand An Hidden Root. ")
|
|
|
|
if not item.HasPlus():
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self._sendEvent:
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = item
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event) and not event.IsAllowed():
|
|
# cancelled by program
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
item.Expand()
|
|
|
|
if not self._sendEvent:
|
|
# We are in ExpandAll/ExpandAllChildren
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.RefreshSubtree(item)
|
|
|
|
if self._hasWindows:
|
|
# We hide the associated window here, we may show it after
|
|
self.HideWindows()
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ExpandAllChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Expands all the items children of the input item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method suppresses the ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED`` events because expanding many items int the
|
|
control would be too slow then.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._sendEvent = False
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT) or item != self.GetRootItem():
|
|
self.Expand(item)
|
|
if not self.IsExpanded(item):
|
|
self._sendEvent = True
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(item)
|
|
|
|
while child:
|
|
self.ExpandAllChildren(child)
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
self._sendEvent = True
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ExpandAll(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Expands all :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` items.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method suppresses the ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDING`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_EXPANDED`` events because expanding many items int the
|
|
control would be too slow then.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._anchor:
|
|
self.ExpandAllChildren(self._anchor)
|
|
|
|
self._sendEvent = True
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Collapse(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Collapse an item, sending a ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED`` events.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if you try to collapse a hidden root (i.e., when the ``TR_HIDE_ROOT``
|
|
style is set for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT) and item == self.GetRootItem():
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: Can't Collapse An Hidden Root. ")
|
|
|
|
if not item.IsExpanded():
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSING, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = item
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event) and not event.IsAllowed():
|
|
# cancelled by program
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
self.ChildrenClosing(item)
|
|
item.Collapse()
|
|
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
if self._hasWindows:
|
|
self.HideWindows()
|
|
|
|
self.AdjustMyScrollbars()
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_COLLAPSED)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CollapseAndReset(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Collapse the given item and deletes its children.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.Collapse(item)
|
|
self.DeleteChildren(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Toggle(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Toggles the item state (collapsed/expanded).
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
self.Collapse(item)
|
|
else:
|
|
self.Expand(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HideWindows(self):
|
|
""" Hides the windows associated to the items. Used internally. """
|
|
|
|
for child in self._itemWithWindow:
|
|
if not self.IsVisible(child):
|
|
wnd = child.GetWindow()
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
wnd.Hide()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Unselect(self):
|
|
""" Unselects the current selection. """
|
|
|
|
if self._current:
|
|
self._current.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._current)
|
|
|
|
self._current = None
|
|
self._select_me = None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def UnselectAllChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Unselects all the children of the given item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
item.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
if item.HasChildren():
|
|
for child in item.GetChildren():
|
|
self.UnselectAllChildren(child)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SelectAllChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Selects all the children of the given item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if used without the ``TR_EXTENDED`` or ``TR_MULTIPLE`` style set.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method can be used only if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_MULTIPLE`` or ``TR_EXTENDED``
|
|
style set.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE) and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_EXTENDED):
|
|
raise Exception("SelectAllChildren can be used only with multiple selection enabled.")
|
|
|
|
if not item.IsSelected():
|
|
item.SetHilight(True)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
if item.HasChildren():
|
|
for child in item.GetChildren():
|
|
self.SelectAllChildren(child)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def UnselectAll(self):
|
|
""" Unselect all the items. """
|
|
|
|
rootItem = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
|
|
# the tree might not have the root item at all
|
|
if rootItem:
|
|
self.UnselectAllChildren(rootItem)
|
|
|
|
self.Unselect()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SelectAll(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Selects all the item in the tree.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if used without the ``TR_EXTENDED`` or ``TR_MULTIPLE`` style set.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method can be used only if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_MULTIPLE`` or ``TR_EXTENDED``
|
|
style set.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE) and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_EXTENDED):
|
|
raise Exception("SelectAll can be used only with multiple selection enabled.")
|
|
|
|
rootItem = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
|
|
# the tree might not have the root item at all
|
|
if rootItem:
|
|
self.SelectAllChildren(rootItem)
|
|
|
|
|
|
# Recursive function !
|
|
# To stop we must have crt_item<last_item
|
|
# Algorithm :
|
|
# Tag all next children, when no more children,
|
|
# Move to parent (not to tag)
|
|
# Keep going... if we found last_item, we stop.
|
|
|
|
def TagNextChildren(self, crt_item, last_item, select):
|
|
""" Used internally. """
|
|
|
|
parent = crt_item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
if parent == None: # This is root item
|
|
return self.TagAllChildrenUntilLast(crt_item, last_item, select)
|
|
|
|
children = parent.GetChildren()
|
|
index = children.index(crt_item)
|
|
|
|
count = len(children)
|
|
|
|
for n in range(index+1, count):
|
|
if self.TagAllChildrenUntilLast(children[n], last_item, select):
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
return self.TagNextChildren(parent, last_item, select)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def TagAllChildrenUntilLast(self, crt_item, last_item, select):
|
|
""" Used internally. """
|
|
|
|
crt_item.SetHilight(select)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(crt_item)
|
|
|
|
if crt_item == last_item:
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
if crt_item.HasChildren():
|
|
for child in crt_item.GetChildren():
|
|
if self.TagAllChildrenUntilLast(child, last_item, select):
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SelectItemRange(self, item1, item2):
|
|
"""
|
|
Selects all the items between `item1` and `item2`.
|
|
|
|
:param `item1`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`, representing the first
|
|
item in the range to select;
|
|
:param `item2`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`, representing the last
|
|
item in the range to select.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if used without the ``TR_EXTENDED`` or ``TR_MULTIPLE`` style set.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method can be used only if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_MULTIPLE`` or ``TR_EXTENDED``
|
|
style set.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE) and not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_EXTENDED):
|
|
raise Exception("SelectItemRange can be used only with multiple selection enabled.")
|
|
|
|
self._select_me = None
|
|
|
|
# item2 is not necessary after item1
|
|
# choice first' and 'last' between item1 and item2
|
|
first = (item1.GetY() < item2.GetY() and [item1] or [item2])[0]
|
|
last = (item1.GetY() < item2.GetY() and [item2] or [item1])[0]
|
|
|
|
select = self._current.IsSelected()
|
|
|
|
if self.TagAllChildrenUntilLast(first, last, select):
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
self.TagNextChildren(first, last, select)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DoSelectItem(self, item, unselect_others=True, extended_select=False, from_key=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Actually selects/unselects an item, sending ``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING`` and
|
|
``EVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED`` events.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `unselect_others`: if ``True``, all the other selected items are
|
|
unselected.
|
|
:param bool `extended_select`: ``True`` if the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` is using the
|
|
``TR_EXTENDED`` style;
|
|
:param bool `from_key`: ``True`` to indicate that the selection was made via a keyboard
|
|
key, ``False`` if it was a mouse selection.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._select_me = None
|
|
|
|
is_single = not (self.GetAGWWindowStyleFlag() & TR_MULTIPLE)
|
|
|
|
# to keep going anyhow !!!
|
|
if is_single:
|
|
if item.IsSelected() and not from_key:
|
|
# Handles hypertext items
|
|
self.HandleHyperLink(item)
|
|
return # nothing else to do
|
|
unselect_others = True
|
|
extended_select = False
|
|
|
|
elif unselect_others and item.IsSelected():
|
|
|
|
# selection change if there is more than one item currently selected
|
|
if len(self.GetSelections()) == 1 and not from_key:
|
|
# Handles hypertext items
|
|
self.HandleHyperLink(item)
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGING, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = item
|
|
event._itemOld = self._current
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
# TODO : Here we don't send any selection mode yet !
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event) and not event.IsAllowed():
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
parent = self.GetItemParent(item)
|
|
while parent:
|
|
if not self.IsExpanded(parent):
|
|
self.Expand(parent)
|
|
|
|
parent = self.GetItemParent(parent)
|
|
|
|
# ctrl press
|
|
if unselect_others:
|
|
if is_single:
|
|
self.Unselect() # to speed up thing
|
|
else:
|
|
self.UnselectAll()
|
|
|
|
# shift press
|
|
if extended_select:
|
|
if not self._current:
|
|
self._current = self._key_current = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
|
|
# don't change the mark (self._current)
|
|
self.SelectItemRange(self._current, item)
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
select = True # the default
|
|
|
|
# Check if we need to toggle hilight (ctrl mode)
|
|
if not unselect_others:
|
|
select = not item.IsSelected()
|
|
|
|
self._current = self._key_current = item
|
|
self._current.SetHilight(select)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._current)
|
|
|
|
# This can cause idle processing to select the root
|
|
# if no item is selected, so it must be after the
|
|
# selection is set
|
|
self.EnsureVisible(item)
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_TREE_SEL_CHANGED)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
if not from_key:
|
|
# Handles hypertext items
|
|
self.HandleHyperLink(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SelectItem(self, item, select=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Selects/deselects an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `select`: ``True`` to select an item, ``False`` to deselect it.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if select:
|
|
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(item, not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE))
|
|
|
|
else: # deselect
|
|
|
|
item.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def FillArray(self, item, array=[]):
|
|
"""
|
|
Internal function. Used to populate an array of selected items when
|
|
the style ``TR_MULTIPLE`` is used.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param list `array`: a Python list containing the selected items.
|
|
|
|
:return: A Python list containing the selected items.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not array:
|
|
array = []
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
array.append(item)
|
|
|
|
if item.HasChildren() and item.IsExpanded():
|
|
for child in item.GetChildren():
|
|
array = self.FillArray(child, array)
|
|
|
|
return array
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetSelections(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns a list of selected items.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method can be used only if :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has the ``TR_MULTIPLE`` or ``TR_EXTENDED``
|
|
style set.
|
|
|
|
:return: A Python list containing the selected items, all instances of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
array = []
|
|
idRoot = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
if idRoot:
|
|
array = self.FillArray(idRoot, array)
|
|
|
|
#else: the tree is empty, so no selections
|
|
|
|
return array
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HandleHyperLink(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the hyperlink items, sending the ``EVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK`` event.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.IsItemHyperText(item):
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_HYPERLINK, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = item
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def EnsureVisible(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Scrolls and/or expands items to ensure that the given item is visible.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# first expand all parent branches
|
|
parent = item.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
while parent and parent != self._anchor:
|
|
self.Expand(parent)
|
|
parent = parent.GetParent()
|
|
else:
|
|
while parent:
|
|
self.Expand(parent)
|
|
parent = parent.GetParent()
|
|
|
|
self.ScrollTo(item)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def ScrollTo(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Scrolls the specified item into view.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not item:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
# We have to call this here because the label in
|
|
# question might just have been added and no screen
|
|
# update taken place.
|
|
if self._dirty:
|
|
if wx.Platform in ["__WXMSW__", "__WXMAC__"]:
|
|
self.Update()
|
|
else:
|
|
wx.SafeYield()
|
|
|
|
# now scroll to the item
|
|
item_y = item.GetY()
|
|
start_x, start_y = self.GetViewStart()
|
|
start_y *= _PIXELS_PER_UNIT
|
|
|
|
client_w, client_h = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
|
|
x, y = 0, 0
|
|
|
|
if item_y < start_y+3:
|
|
|
|
# going down
|
|
x, y = self._anchor.GetSize(x, y, self)
|
|
y += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT + 2 # one more scrollbar unit + 2 pixels
|
|
x += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT + 2 # one more scrollbar unit + 2 pixels
|
|
x_pos = self.GetScrollPos(wx.HORIZONTAL)
|
|
# Item should appear at top
|
|
self.SetScrollbars(_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, _PIXELS_PER_UNIT, x//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, y//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, x_pos, item_y//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
elif item_y+self.GetLineHeight(item) > start_y+client_h:
|
|
|
|
# going up
|
|
x, y = self._anchor.GetSize(x, y, self)
|
|
y += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT + 2 # one more scrollbar unit + 2 pixels
|
|
x += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT + 2 # one more scrollbar unit + 2 pixels
|
|
item_y += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT+2
|
|
x_pos = self.GetScrollPos(wx.HORIZONTAL)
|
|
# Item should appear at bottom
|
|
self.SetScrollbars(_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, _PIXELS_PER_UNIT, x//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, y//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, x_pos, (item_y+self.GetLineHeight(item)-client_h)//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT )
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnCompareItems(self, item1, item2):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns whether 2 items have the same text.
|
|
|
|
Override this function in the derived class to change the sort order of the items
|
|
in the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`. The function should return a negative, zero or positive
|
|
value if the first item is less than, equal to or greater than the second one.
|
|
|
|
:param `item1`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `item2`: another instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: The return value is negative if `item1` < `item2`, zero if `item1` == `item2`
|
|
and strictly positive if `item1` < `item2`.
|
|
|
|
:note: The base class version compares items alphabetically.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return cmp(self.GetItemText(item1), self.GetItemText(item2))
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SortChildren(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sorts the children of the given item using the :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.OnCompareItems` method of
|
|
:class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:note: You should override the :meth:`~CustomTreeCtrl.OnCompareItems` method in your derived class to change
|
|
the sort order (the default is ascending case-sensitive alphabetical order).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
|
|
if len(children) > 1:
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
children = six.sort(children, self.OnCompareItems)
|
|
item._children = children
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetImageList(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the normal image list associated with :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._imageListNormal
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetButtonsImageList(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the buttons image list associated with :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` (from
|
|
which application-defined button images are taken).
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._imageListButtons
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetStateImageList(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the state image list associated with :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` (from which
|
|
application-defined state images are taken).
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._imageListState
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetImageListCheck(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the image list used to build the check/radio buttons in :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._imageListCheck
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetLeftImageList(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the image list for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` filled with images to be used on
|
|
the leftmost part of the client area. Any item can have a leftmost image associated
|
|
with it.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._imageListLeft
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CalculateLineHeight(self):
|
|
""" Calculates the height of a line. """
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self._lineHeight = dc.GetCharHeight()
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListNormal:
|
|
|
|
# Calculate a self._lineHeight value from the normal Image sizes.
|
|
# May be toggle off. Then CustomTreeCtrl will spread when
|
|
# necessary (which might look ugly).
|
|
n = self._imageListNormal.GetImageCount()
|
|
|
|
for i in range(n):
|
|
|
|
width, height = self._imageListNormal.GetSize(i)
|
|
|
|
if height > self._lineHeight:
|
|
self._lineHeight = height
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListButtons:
|
|
|
|
# Calculate a self._lineHeight value from the Button image sizes.
|
|
# May be toggle off. Then CustomTreeCtrl will spread when
|
|
# necessary (which might look ugly).
|
|
n = self._imageListButtons.GetImageCount()
|
|
|
|
for i in range(n):
|
|
|
|
width, height = self._imageListButtons.GetSize(i)
|
|
|
|
if height > self._lineHeight:
|
|
self._lineHeight = height
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListCheck:
|
|
|
|
# Calculate a self._lineHeight value from the check/radio image sizes.
|
|
# May be toggle off. Then CustomTreeCtrl will spread when
|
|
# necessary (which might look ugly).
|
|
n = self._imageListCheck.GetImageCount()
|
|
|
|
for i in range(n):
|
|
|
|
width, height = self._imageListCheck.GetSize(i)
|
|
|
|
if height > self._lineHeight:
|
|
self._lineHeight = height
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListLeft:
|
|
|
|
# Calculate a self._lineHeight value from the leftmost image sizes.
|
|
# May be toggle off. Then CustomTreeCtrl will spread when
|
|
# necessary (which might look ugly).
|
|
n = self._imageListLeft.GetImageCount()
|
|
|
|
for i in range(n):
|
|
|
|
width, height = self._imageListLeft.GetSize(i)
|
|
|
|
if height > self._lineHeight:
|
|
self._lineHeight = height
|
|
|
|
if self._lineHeight < 30:
|
|
self._lineHeight += 2 # at least 2 pixels
|
|
else:
|
|
self._lineHeight += self._lineHeight//10 # otherwise 10% extra spacing
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the normal image list for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._ownsImageListNormal:
|
|
del self._imageListNormal
|
|
|
|
self._imageListNormal = imageList
|
|
self._ownsImageListNormal = False
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
# Don't do any drawing if we're setting the list to NULL,
|
|
# since we may be in the process of deleting the tree control.
|
|
if imageList:
|
|
self.CalculateLineHeight()
|
|
|
|
# We gray out the image list to use the grayed icons with disabled items
|
|
sz = imageList.GetSize(0)
|
|
self._grayedImageList = wx.ImageList(sz[0], sz[1], True, 0)
|
|
|
|
for ii in range(imageList.GetImageCount()):
|
|
bmp = imageList.GetBitmap(ii)
|
|
newbmp = MakeDisabledBitmap(bmp)
|
|
self._grayedImageList.Add(newbmp)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetLeftImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the image list for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` filled with images to be used on
|
|
the leftmost part of the client area. Any item can have a leftmost image associated
|
|
with it.
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._imageListLeft = imageList
|
|
self._ownsImageListLeft = False
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
# Don't do any drawing if we're setting the list to NULL,
|
|
# since we may be in the process of deleting the tree control.
|
|
if imageList:
|
|
self.CalculateLineHeight()
|
|
|
|
# We gray out the image list to use the grayed icons with disabled items
|
|
sz = imageList.GetSize(0)
|
|
self._grayedImageListLeft = wx.ImageList(sz[0], sz[1], True, 0)
|
|
|
|
for ii in range(imageList.GetImageCount()):
|
|
bmp = imageList.GetBitmap(ii)
|
|
newbmp = MakeDisabledBitmap(bmp)
|
|
self._grayedImageListLeft.Add(newbmp)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetStateImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the state image list for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` (from which application-defined
|
|
state images are taken).
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._ownsImageListState:
|
|
del self._imageListState
|
|
|
|
self._imageListState = imageList
|
|
self._ownsImageListState = False
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetButtonsImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the buttons image list for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` (from which application-defined
|
|
button images are taken).
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._ownsImageListButtons:
|
|
del self._imageListButtons
|
|
|
|
self._imageListButtons = imageList
|
|
self._ownsImageListButtons = False
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
self.CalculateLineHeight()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetImageListCheck(self, sizex, sizey, imglist=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Sets the checkbox/radiobutton image list.
|
|
|
|
:param integer `sizex`: the width of the bitmaps in the `imglist`, in pixels;
|
|
:param integer `sizey`: the height of the bitmaps in the `imglist`, in pixels;
|
|
:param `imglist`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Image list to hold disabled versions of each control
|
|
self._grayedCheckList = wx.ImageList(sizex, sizey, True, 0)
|
|
|
|
if imglist is None:
|
|
|
|
self._imageListCheck = wx.ImageList(sizex, sizey)
|
|
|
|
# Get the Checkboxes
|
|
self._imageListCheck.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=True,
|
|
checked=True,
|
|
enabled=True,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
self._grayedCheckList.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=True,
|
|
checked=True,
|
|
enabled=False,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
|
|
self._imageListCheck.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=True,
|
|
checked=False,
|
|
enabled=True,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
self._grayedCheckList.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=True,
|
|
checked=False,
|
|
enabled=False,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
|
|
self._imageListCheck.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=True,
|
|
checked=2,
|
|
enabled=True,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
self._grayedCheckList.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=True,
|
|
checked=2,
|
|
enabled=False,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
|
|
# Get the Radio Buttons
|
|
self._imageListCheck.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=False,
|
|
checked=True,
|
|
enabled=True,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
self._grayedCheckList.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=False,
|
|
checked=True,
|
|
enabled=False,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
|
|
self._imageListCheck.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=False,
|
|
checked=False,
|
|
enabled=True,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
self._grayedCheckList.Add(self.GetControlBmp(checkbox=False,
|
|
checked=False,
|
|
enabled=False,
|
|
x=sizex, y=sizey))
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
sizex, sizey = imglist.GetSize(0)
|
|
self._imageListCheck = imglist
|
|
|
|
for ii in range(self._imageListCheck.GetImageCount()):
|
|
|
|
bmp = self._imageListCheck.GetBitmap(ii)
|
|
newbmp = MakeDisabledBitmap(bmp)
|
|
self._grayedCheckList.Add(newbmp)
|
|
|
|
self._dirty = True
|
|
|
|
if imglist:
|
|
self.CalculateLineHeight()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AssignImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Assigns the normal image list.
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.SetImageList(imageList)
|
|
self._ownsImageListNormal = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AssignStateImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Assigns the state image list.
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.SetStateImageList(imageList)
|
|
self._ownsImageListState = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AssignButtonsImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Assigns the button image list.
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.SetButtonsImageList(imageList)
|
|
self._ownsImageListButtons = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def AssignLeftImageList(self, imageList):
|
|
"""
|
|
Assigns the image list for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` filled with images to be used on
|
|
the leftmost part of the client area. Any item can have a leftmost image associated
|
|
with it.
|
|
|
|
:param `imageList`: an instance of :class:`ImageList`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.SetLeftImageList(imageList)
|
|
self._ownsImageListLeft = True
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# helpers
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def AdjustMyScrollbars(self):
|
|
""" Internal method used to adjust the :class:`ScrolledWindow` scrollbars. """
|
|
|
|
if self._anchor:
|
|
|
|
x, y = self._anchor.GetSize(0, 0, self)
|
|
y += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT + 2 # one more scrollbar unit + 2 pixels
|
|
x += _PIXELS_PER_UNIT + 2 # one more scrollbar unit + 2 pixels
|
|
x_pos = self.GetScrollPos(wx.HORIZONTAL)
|
|
y_pos = self.GetScrollPos(wx.VERTICAL)
|
|
self.SetScrollbars(_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, _PIXELS_PER_UNIT, x//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, y//_PIXELS_PER_UNIT, x_pos, y_pos)
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
self.SetScrollbars(0, 0, 0, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetLineHeight(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the line height for the given item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
:return: the item height, in pixels.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.GetAGWWindowStyleFlag() & TR_HAS_VARIABLE_ROW_HEIGHT:
|
|
return int(item.GetHeight())
|
|
else:
|
|
return int(self._lineHeight)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DrawVerticalGradient(self, dc, rect, hasfocus):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gradient fill from colour 1 to colour 2 from top to bottom.
|
|
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param Rect `rect`: the rectangle to be filled with the gradient shading;
|
|
:param bool `hasfocus`: ``True`` if the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has focus, ``False``
|
|
otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
oldpen = dc.GetPen()
|
|
oldbrush = dc.GetBrush()
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.TRANSPARENT_PEN)
|
|
|
|
# calculate gradient coefficients
|
|
if hasfocus:
|
|
col2 = self._secondcolour
|
|
col1 = self._firstcolour
|
|
else:
|
|
col2 = self._hilightUnfocusedBrush.GetColour()
|
|
col1 = self._hilightUnfocusedBrush2.GetColour()
|
|
|
|
r1, g1, b1 = int(col1.Red()), int(col1.Green()), int(col1.Blue())
|
|
r2, g2, b2 = int(col2.Red()), int(col2.Green()), int(col2.Blue())
|
|
|
|
flrect = float(rect.height)
|
|
|
|
rstep = float((r2 - r1)) / flrect
|
|
gstep = float((g2 - g1)) / flrect
|
|
bstep = float((b2 - b1)) / flrect
|
|
|
|
rf, gf, bf = 0, 0, 0
|
|
|
|
for y in range(rect.y, rect.y + rect.height):
|
|
currCol = (r1 + rf, g1 + gf, b1 + bf)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.Brush(currCol, wx.BRUSHSTYLE_SOLID))
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(rect.x, y, rect.width, 1)
|
|
rf = rf + rstep
|
|
gf = gf + gstep
|
|
bf = bf + bstep
|
|
|
|
dc.SetPen(oldpen)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.TRANSPARENT_BRUSH)
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(rect)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(oldbrush)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DrawHorizontalGradient(self, dc, rect, hasfocus):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gradient fill from colour 1 to colour 2 from left to right.
|
|
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param Rect `rect`: the rectangle to be filled with the gradient shading;
|
|
:param bool `hasfocus`: ``True`` if the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has focus, ``False``
|
|
otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
oldpen = dc.GetPen()
|
|
oldbrush = dc.GetBrush()
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.TRANSPARENT_PEN)
|
|
|
|
# calculate gradient coefficients
|
|
|
|
if hasfocus:
|
|
col2 = self._secondcolour
|
|
col1 = self._firstcolour
|
|
else:
|
|
col2 = self._hilightUnfocusedBrush.GetColour()
|
|
col1 = self._hilightUnfocusedBrush2.GetColour()
|
|
|
|
r1, g1, b1 = int(col1.Red()), int(col1.Green()), int(col1.Blue())
|
|
r2, g2, b2 = int(col2.Red()), int(col2.Green()), int(col2.Blue())
|
|
|
|
flrect = float(rect.width)
|
|
|
|
rstep = float((r2 - r1)) / flrect
|
|
gstep = float((g2 - g1)) / flrect
|
|
bstep = float((b2 - b1)) / flrect
|
|
|
|
rf, gf, bf = 0, 0, 0
|
|
|
|
for x in range(rect.x, rect.x + rect.width):
|
|
currCol = (int(r1 + rf), int(g1 + gf), int(b1 + bf))
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.Brush(currCol, wx.BRUSHSTYLE_SOLID))
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(x, rect.y, 1, rect.height)
|
|
rf = rf + rstep
|
|
gf = gf + gstep
|
|
bf = bf + bstep
|
|
|
|
dc.SetPen(oldpen)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.TRANSPARENT_BRUSH)
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(rect)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(oldbrush)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DrawVistaRectangle(self, dc, rect, hasfocus):
|
|
"""
|
|
Draws the selected item(s) with the Windows Vista style.
|
|
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param Rect `rect`: the rectangle to be filled with the gradient shading;
|
|
:param bool `hasfocus`: ``True`` if the main :class:`CustomTreeCtrl` has focus, ``False``
|
|
otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if hasfocus:
|
|
|
|
outer = _rgbSelectOuter
|
|
inner = _rgbSelectInner
|
|
top = _rgbSelectTop
|
|
bottom = _rgbSelectBottom
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
outer = _rgbNoFocusOuter
|
|
inner = _rgbNoFocusInner
|
|
top = _rgbNoFocusTop
|
|
bottom = _rgbNoFocusBottom
|
|
|
|
oldpen = dc.GetPen()
|
|
oldbrush = dc.GetBrush()
|
|
|
|
bdrRect = wx.Rect(*rect.Get())
|
|
filRect = wx.Rect(*rect.Get())
|
|
filRect.Deflate(1,1)
|
|
|
|
r1, g1, b1 = int(top.Red()), int(top.Green()), int(top.Blue())
|
|
r2, g2, b2 = int(bottom.Red()), int(bottom.Green()), int(bottom.Blue())
|
|
|
|
flrect = float(filRect.height)
|
|
if flrect < 1:
|
|
flrect = self._lineHeight
|
|
|
|
rstep = float((r2 - r1)) / flrect
|
|
gstep = float((g2 - g1)) / flrect
|
|
bstep = float((b2 - b1)) / flrect
|
|
|
|
rf, gf, bf = 0, 0, 0
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.TRANSPARENT_PEN)
|
|
|
|
for y in range(filRect.y, filRect.y + filRect.height):
|
|
currCol = (r1 + rf, g1 + gf, b1 + bf)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.Brush(currCol, wx.BRUSHSTYLE_SOLID))
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(filRect.x, y, filRect.width, 1)
|
|
rf = rf + rstep
|
|
gf = gf + gstep
|
|
bf = bf + bstep
|
|
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.TRANSPARENT_BRUSH)
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.Pen(outer))
|
|
dc.DrawRoundedRectangle(bdrRect, 3)
|
|
bdrRect.Deflate(1, 1)
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.Pen(inner))
|
|
dc.DrawRoundedRectangle(bdrRect, 2)
|
|
|
|
dc.SetPen(oldpen)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(oldbrush)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def PaintItem(self, item, dc, level, align):
|
|
"""
|
|
Actually draws an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param integer `level`: the item level in the tree hierarchy;
|
|
:param integer `align`: an integer specifying the alignment type:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`align` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 No horizontal alignment of windows (in items with windows).
|
|
1 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the same horizontal position.
|
|
2 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
attr = item.GetAttributes()
|
|
|
|
if attr and attr.HasFont():
|
|
dc.SetFont(attr.GetFont())
|
|
else:
|
|
if item.IsBold():
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._boldFont)
|
|
elif item.IsItalic():
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._italicFont)
|
|
if item.IsHyperText():
|
|
dc.SetFont(self.GetHyperTextFont())
|
|
if item.GetVisited():
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(self.GetHyperTextVisitedColour())
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(self.GetHyperTextNewColour())
|
|
|
|
text_w, text_h, dummy = dc.GetFullMultiLineTextExtent(item.GetText())
|
|
w, h = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
|
|
image = item.GetCurrentImage()
|
|
checkimage = item.GetCurrentCheckedImage()
|
|
leftimage = _NO_IMAGE
|
|
separator = item.IsSeparator()
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListLeft:
|
|
leftimage = item.GetLeftImage()
|
|
|
|
image_w, image_h = 0, 0
|
|
|
|
if image != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListNormal:
|
|
|
|
image_w, image_h = self._imageListNormal.GetSize(image)
|
|
image_w += 4
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
image = _NO_IMAGE
|
|
|
|
if item.GetType() != 0:
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = self._imageListCheck.GetSize(item.GetType())
|
|
wcheck += 4
|
|
else:
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = 0, 0
|
|
|
|
if leftimage != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
l_image_w, l_image_h = self._imageListLeft.GetSize(leftimage)
|
|
|
|
total_h = self.GetLineHeight(item)
|
|
drawItemBackground = False
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
|
|
# under mac selections are only a rectangle in case they don't have the focus
|
|
if wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__":
|
|
if not self._hasFocus:
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.TRANSPARENT_BRUSH)
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.Pen(wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHT), 1, wx.SOLID))
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.SetBrush(self._hilightBrush)
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.SetBrush((self._hasFocus and [self._hilightBrush] or [self._hilightUnfocusedBrush])[0])
|
|
drawItemBackground = True
|
|
else:
|
|
if attr and attr.HasBackgroundColour():
|
|
drawItemBackground = True
|
|
colBg = attr.GetBackgroundColour()
|
|
else:
|
|
colBg = self._backgroundColour
|
|
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.Brush(colBg, wx.BRUSHSTYLE_SOLID))
|
|
if attr and attr.HasBorderColour():
|
|
colBorder = attr.GetBorderColour()
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.Pen(colBorder, 1))
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.TRANSPARENT_PEN)
|
|
|
|
offset = (self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ROW_LINES) and [1] or [0])[0]
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT):
|
|
x = 0
|
|
|
|
itemrect = wx.Rect(x, item.GetY()+offset, w, total_h-offset)
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
if self._usegradients:
|
|
if self._gradientstyle == 0: # Horizontal
|
|
self.DrawHorizontalGradient(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
else: # Vertical
|
|
self.DrawVerticalGradient(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
elif self._vistaselection:
|
|
self.DrawVistaRectangle(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
else:
|
|
if wx.Platform in ["__WXGTK2__", "__WXMAC__"]:
|
|
flags = wx.CONTROL_SELECTED
|
|
if self._hasFocus: flags = flags | wx.CONTROL_FOCUSED
|
|
wx.RendererNative.Get().DrawItemSelectionRect(self, dc, itemrect, flags)
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(itemrect)
|
|
else:
|
|
if drawItemBackground:
|
|
minusicon = wcheck + image_w - 2
|
|
itemrect = wx.Rect(item.GetX()+minusicon,
|
|
item.GetY()+offset,
|
|
item.GetWidth()-minusicon,
|
|
total_h-offset)
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(itemrect)
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
|
|
# If it's selected, and there's an image, then we should
|
|
# take care to leave the area under the image painted in the
|
|
# background colour.
|
|
|
|
wnd = item.GetWindow()
|
|
wndx = 0
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
wndx, wndy = item.GetWindowSize()
|
|
|
|
if separator:
|
|
item_width = w
|
|
else:
|
|
item_width = item.GetWidth() - image_w - wcheck + 2 - wndx
|
|
|
|
itemrect = wx.Rect(item.GetX() + wcheck + image_w - 2,
|
|
item.GetY()+offset,
|
|
item_width,
|
|
total_h-offset)
|
|
|
|
if self._usegradients:
|
|
if self._gradientstyle == 0: # Horizontal
|
|
self.DrawHorizontalGradient(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
else: # Vertical
|
|
self.DrawVerticalGradient(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
elif self._vistaselection:
|
|
self.DrawVistaRectangle(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
else:
|
|
if wx.Platform in ["__WXGTK2__", "__WXMAC__"]:
|
|
flags = wx.CONTROL_SELECTED
|
|
if self._hasFocus: flags = flags | wx.CONTROL_FOCUSED
|
|
wx.RendererNative.Get().DrawItemSelectionRect(self, dc, itemrect, flags)
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(itemrect)
|
|
|
|
# On GTK+ 2, drawing a 'normal' background is wrong for themes that
|
|
# don't allow backgrounds to be customized. Not drawing the background,
|
|
# except for custom item backgrounds, works for both kinds of theme.
|
|
elif drawItemBackground:
|
|
|
|
minusicon = wcheck + image_w - 2
|
|
|
|
if separator:
|
|
item_width = w
|
|
else:
|
|
item_width = item.GetWidth()-minusicon
|
|
|
|
itemrect = wx.Rect(item.GetX()+minusicon,
|
|
item.GetY()+offset,
|
|
item_width,
|
|
total_h-offset)
|
|
|
|
if self._usegradients and self._hasFocus:
|
|
if self._gradientstyle == 0: # Horizontal
|
|
self.DrawHorizontalGradient(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
else: # Vertical
|
|
self.DrawVerticalGradient(dc, itemrect, self._hasFocus)
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.DrawRectangle(itemrect)
|
|
|
|
if image != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
|
|
dc.SetClippingRegion(item.GetX(), item.GetY(), wcheck+image_w-2, total_h)
|
|
if item.IsEnabled():
|
|
imglist = self._imageListNormal
|
|
else:
|
|
imglist = self._grayedImageList
|
|
|
|
imglist.Draw(image, dc,
|
|
item.GetX() + wcheck,
|
|
item.GetY() + ((total_h > image_h) and [(total_h-image_h)//2] or [0])[0],
|
|
wx.IMAGELIST_DRAW_TRANSPARENT)
|
|
|
|
dc.DestroyClippingRegion()
|
|
|
|
if wcheck:
|
|
if item.IsEnabled():
|
|
imglist = self._imageListCheck
|
|
else:
|
|
imglist = self._grayedCheckList
|
|
|
|
imglist.Draw(checkimage, dc,
|
|
item.GetX(),
|
|
item.GetY() + ((total_h > hcheck) and [(total_h-hcheck)//2] or [0])[0],
|
|
wx.IMAGELIST_DRAW_TRANSPARENT)
|
|
|
|
if leftimage != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
if item.IsEnabled():
|
|
imglist = self._imageListLeft
|
|
else:
|
|
imglist = self._grayedImageListLeft
|
|
|
|
imglist.Draw(leftimage, dc,
|
|
4,
|
|
item.GetY() + ((total_h > l_image_h) and [(total_h-l_image_h)//2] or [0])[0],
|
|
wx.IMAGELIST_DRAW_TRANSPARENT)
|
|
|
|
dc.SetBackgroundMode(wx.TRANSPARENT)
|
|
extraH = ((total_h > text_h) and [(total_h - text_h)//2] or [0])[0]
|
|
|
|
textrect = wx.Rect(wcheck + image_w + item.GetX(), item.GetY() + extraH, text_w, text_h)
|
|
|
|
itemText = item.GetText()
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS) and not separator:
|
|
xa, ya = self.CalcScrolledPosition((0, item.GetY()))
|
|
maxsize = w - (wcheck + image_w + item.GetX()) + xa
|
|
itemText = ChopText(dc, itemText, maxsize)
|
|
|
|
if not item.IsEnabled():
|
|
foreground = dc.GetTextForeground()
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(self._disabledColour)
|
|
dc.DrawLabel(itemText, textrect)
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(foreground)
|
|
else:
|
|
if wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__" and item.IsSelected() and self._hasFocus:
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(wx.WHITE)
|
|
dc.DrawLabel(itemText, textrect)
|
|
|
|
wnd = item.GetWindow()
|
|
if wnd:
|
|
wndx = wcheck + image_w + item.GetX() + text_w + 4
|
|
xa, ya = self.CalcScrolledPosition((0, item.GetY()))
|
|
wndx += xa
|
|
if item.GetHeight() > item.GetWindowSize()[1]:
|
|
ya += (item.GetHeight() - item.GetWindowSize()[1])//2
|
|
|
|
if align == 1:
|
|
# Horizontal alignment of windows
|
|
if level in self.absoluteWindows:
|
|
wndx = self.absoluteWindows[level] + item.GetX() + 2 + xa
|
|
|
|
elif align == 2:
|
|
# Rightmost alignment of windows
|
|
wndx = w - item.GetWindowSize().x - 2 + xa
|
|
|
|
if not wnd.IsShown():
|
|
wnd.Show()
|
|
if wnd.GetPosition() != (wndx, ya):
|
|
wnd.SetPosition((wndx, ya))
|
|
|
|
if separator:
|
|
oldPen = dc.GetPen()
|
|
|
|
if item.IsEnabled():
|
|
if attr and attr.HasTextColour():
|
|
separatorPen = wx.Pen(attr.GetTextColour(), 1)
|
|
else:
|
|
separatorPen = self._separatorPen
|
|
else:
|
|
separatorPen = wx.GREY_PEN
|
|
|
|
dc.SetPen(separatorPen)
|
|
dc.DrawLine(item.GetX()+2, item.GetY()+total_h//2, w, item.GetY()+total_h//2)
|
|
dc.SetPen(oldPen)
|
|
|
|
# restore normal font
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._normalFont)
|
|
|
|
|
|
# Now y stands for the top of the item, whereas it used to stand for middle !
|
|
def PaintLevel(self, item, dc, level, y, align):
|
|
"""
|
|
Paint a level in the hierarchy of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param integer `level`: the item level in the tree hierarchy;
|
|
:param integer `y`: the current vertical position in the :class:`ScrolledWindow`;
|
|
:param integer `align`: an integer specifying the alignment type:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`align` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 No horizontal alignment of windows (in items with windows).
|
|
1 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the same horizontal position.
|
|
2 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
x = level*self._indent
|
|
|
|
left_image_list = 0
|
|
if self._imageListLeft:
|
|
left_image_list += self._imageListLeft.GetBitmap(0).GetWidth()
|
|
|
|
x += left_image_list
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
|
|
x += self._indent
|
|
|
|
elif level == 0:
|
|
|
|
# always expand hidden root
|
|
origY = y
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
count = len(children)
|
|
|
|
if count > 0:
|
|
n = 0
|
|
while n < count:
|
|
oldY = y
|
|
y = self.PaintLevel(children[n], dc, 1, y, align)
|
|
n = n + 1
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_NO_LINES) and self.HasAGWFlag(TR_LINES_AT_ROOT) and count > 0:
|
|
|
|
# draw line down to last child
|
|
origY += self.GetLineHeight(children[0])>>1
|
|
oldY += self.GetLineHeight(children[n-1])>>1
|
|
oldPen = dc.GetPen()
|
|
dc.SetPen(self._dottedPen)
|
|
dc.DrawLine(3, origY, 3, oldY)
|
|
dc.SetPen(oldPen)
|
|
|
|
return y
|
|
|
|
item.SetX(x+self._spacing)
|
|
item.SetY(y)
|
|
|
|
h = self.GetLineHeight(item)
|
|
y_top = y
|
|
y_mid = y_top + (h>>1)
|
|
y += h
|
|
|
|
exposed_x = dc.LogicalToDeviceX(0)
|
|
exposed_y = dc.LogicalToDeviceY(y_top)
|
|
|
|
if self.IsExposed(exposed_x, exposed_y, 10000, h): # 10000 = very much
|
|
if wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__":
|
|
# don't draw rect outline if we already have the
|
|
# background colour under Mac
|
|
pen = ((item.IsSelected() and self._hasFocus) and [self._borderPen] or [wx.TRANSPARENT_PEN])[0]
|
|
else:
|
|
pen = self._borderPen
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
if (wx.Platform == "__WXMAC__" and self._hasFocus):
|
|
colText = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT)
|
|
else:
|
|
colText = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_HIGHLIGHTTEXT)
|
|
|
|
if self._vistaselection:
|
|
colText = wx.BLACK
|
|
attr = item.GetAttributes()
|
|
|
|
if attr and attr.HasTextColour():
|
|
colText = attr.GetTextColour()
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
attr = item.GetAttributes()
|
|
if attr and attr.HasTextColour():
|
|
colText = attr.GetTextColour()
|
|
else:
|
|
colText = self.GetForegroundColour()
|
|
|
|
# prepare to draw
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(colText)
|
|
dc.SetPen(pen)
|
|
oldpen = pen
|
|
|
|
# draw
|
|
self.PaintItem(item, dc, level, align)
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ROW_LINES):
|
|
|
|
# if the background colour is white, choose a
|
|
# contrasting colour for the lines
|
|
medium_grey = wx.Pen(wx.Colour(200, 200, 200))
|
|
dc.SetPen(((self.GetBackgroundColour() == wx.WHITE) and [medium_grey] or [wx.WHITE_PEN])[0])
|
|
dc.DrawLine(0, y_top, 10000, y_top)
|
|
dc.DrawLine(0, y, 10000, y)
|
|
|
|
# restore DC objects
|
|
dc.SetBrush(wx.WHITE_BRUSH)
|
|
dc.SetTextForeground(wx.BLACK)
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_NO_LINES):
|
|
|
|
# draw the horizontal line here
|
|
dc.SetPen(self._dottedPen)
|
|
x_start = x
|
|
if x > self._indent+left_image_list:
|
|
x_start -= self._indent
|
|
elif self.HasAGWFlag(TR_LINES_AT_ROOT):
|
|
x_start = 3
|
|
dc.DrawLine(x_start, y_mid, x + self._spacing, y_mid)
|
|
dc.SetPen(oldpen)
|
|
|
|
# should the item show a button?
|
|
if item.HasPlus() and self.HasButtons():
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListButtons:
|
|
|
|
# draw the image button here
|
|
image_h = 0
|
|
image_w = 0
|
|
image = (item.IsExpanded() and [TreeItemIcon_Expanded] or [TreeItemIcon_Normal])[0]
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
image += TreeItemIcon_Selected - TreeItemIcon_Normal
|
|
|
|
image_w, image_h = self._imageListButtons.GetSize(image)
|
|
xx = x - image_w//2
|
|
yy = y_mid - image_h//2
|
|
|
|
dc.SetClippingRegion(xx, yy, image_w, image_h)
|
|
self._imageListButtons.Draw(image, dc, xx, yy,
|
|
wx.IMAGELIST_DRAW_TRANSPARENT)
|
|
dc.DestroyClippingRegion()
|
|
|
|
else: # no custom buttons
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_TWIST_BUTTONS):
|
|
# We draw something like the Mac twist buttons
|
|
|
|
dc.SetPen(wx.BLACK_PEN)
|
|
dc.SetBrush(self._hilightBrush)
|
|
button = [wx.Point(), wx.Point(), wx.Point()]
|
|
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
button[0].x = x - 5
|
|
button[0].y = y_mid - 3
|
|
button[1].x = x + 5
|
|
button[1].y = button[0].y
|
|
button[2].x = x
|
|
button[2].y = button[0].y + 6
|
|
else:
|
|
button[0].x = x - 3
|
|
button[0].y = y_mid - 5
|
|
button[1].x = button[0].x
|
|
button[1].y = y_mid + 5
|
|
button[2].x = button[0].x + 5
|
|
button[2].y = y_mid
|
|
|
|
dc.DrawPolygon(button)
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
# These are the standard wx.TreeCtrl buttons as wx.RendererNative knows
|
|
|
|
wImage = 11
|
|
hImage = 11
|
|
|
|
flag = 0
|
|
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
flag |= _CONTROL_EXPANDED
|
|
if item == self._underMouse:
|
|
flag |= _CONTROL_CURRENT
|
|
|
|
self._drawingfunction(self, dc, wx.Rect(x - wImage//2, y_mid - hImage//2, wImage, hImage), flag)
|
|
|
|
if item.IsExpanded():
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
count = len(children)
|
|
|
|
if count > 0:
|
|
|
|
n = 0
|
|
level = level + 1
|
|
|
|
while n < count:
|
|
oldY = y
|
|
y = self.PaintLevel(children[n], dc, level, y, align)
|
|
n = n + 1
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_NO_LINES) and count > 0:
|
|
|
|
# draw line down to last child
|
|
oldY += self.GetLineHeight(children[n-1])>>1
|
|
if self.HasButtons():
|
|
y_mid += 5
|
|
|
|
# Only draw the portion of the line that is visible, in case it is huge
|
|
xOrigin, yOrigin = dc.GetDeviceOrigin()
|
|
yOrigin = abs(yOrigin)
|
|
width, height = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
|
|
# Move end points to the begining/end of the view?
|
|
if y_mid < yOrigin:
|
|
y_mid = yOrigin
|
|
if oldY > yOrigin + height:
|
|
oldY = yOrigin + height
|
|
|
|
# after the adjustments if y_mid is larger than oldY then the line
|
|
# isn't visible at all so don't draw anything
|
|
if y_mid < oldY:
|
|
dc.SetPen(self._dottedPen)
|
|
dc.DrawLine(x, y_mid, x, oldY)
|
|
|
|
return y
|
|
|
|
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# wxWidgets callbacks
|
|
# -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def OnPaint(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_PAINT`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`PaintEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.PaintDC(self)
|
|
self.PrepareDC(dc)
|
|
|
|
if not self._anchor:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._normalFont)
|
|
dc.SetPen(self._dottedPen)
|
|
|
|
align = 0
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS):
|
|
align = 1
|
|
elif self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT):
|
|
align = 2
|
|
|
|
y = 2
|
|
self.PaintLevel(self._anchor, dc, 0, y, align)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnSize(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_SIZE`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`SizeEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ELLIPSIZE_LONG_ITEMS):
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT) and self._itemWithWindow:
|
|
self.RefreshItemWithWindows()
|
|
else:
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnEraseBackground(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`EraseEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Can we actually do something here (or in OnPaint()) To Handle
|
|
# background images that are stretchable or always centered?
|
|
# I tried but I get enormous flickering...
|
|
|
|
if not self._backgroundImage:
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self._imageStretchStyle == _StyleTile:
|
|
dc = event.GetDC()
|
|
|
|
if not dc:
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
rect = self.GetUpdateRegion().GetBox()
|
|
dc.SetClippingRegion(rect)
|
|
|
|
self.TileBackground(dc)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def TileBackground(self, dc):
|
|
"""
|
|
Tiles the background image to fill all the available area.
|
|
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`.
|
|
|
|
.. todo:: Support background images also in stretch and centered modes.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
sz = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
w = self._backgroundImage.GetWidth()
|
|
h = self._backgroundImage.GetHeight()
|
|
|
|
x = 0
|
|
|
|
while x < sz.width:
|
|
y = 0
|
|
|
|
while y < sz.height:
|
|
dc.DrawBitmap(self._backgroundImage, x, y, True)
|
|
y = y + h
|
|
|
|
x = x + w
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnSetFocus(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_SET_FOCUS`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`FocusEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hasFocus = True
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnKillFocus(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_KILL_FOCUS`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`FocusEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._hasFocus = False
|
|
self.RefreshSelected()
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnKeyDown(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles the ``wx.EVT_KEY_DOWN`` event for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`, sending a
|
|
``EVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN`` event.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`KeyEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
te = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_KEY_DOWN, self.GetId())
|
|
te._evtKey = event
|
|
te.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(te):
|
|
# intercepted by the user code
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self._current is None or self._key_current is None:
|
|
|
|
self._current = self._key_current = self.GetFirstVisibleItem()
|
|
|
|
# how should the selection work for this event?
|
|
is_multiple, extended_select, unselect_others = EventFlagsToSelType(self.GetAGWWindowStyleFlag(),
|
|
event.ShiftDown(), event.CmdDown())
|
|
|
|
# + : Expand
|
|
# - : Collaspe
|
|
# * : Expand all/Collapse all
|
|
# ' ' | return : activate
|
|
# up : go up (not last children!)
|
|
# down : go down
|
|
# left : go to parent
|
|
# right : open if parent and go next
|
|
# home : go to root
|
|
# end : go to last item without opening parents
|
|
# alnum : start or continue searching for the item with this prefix
|
|
|
|
keyCode = event.GetKeyCode()
|
|
|
|
if keyCode in [ord("+"), wx.WXK_ADD]: # "+"
|
|
if self._current.HasPlus() and not self.IsExpanded(self._current) and self.IsItemEnabled(self._current):
|
|
self.Expand(self._current)
|
|
|
|
elif keyCode in [ord("*"), wx.WXK_MULTIPLY]: # "*"
|
|
if not self.IsExpanded(self._current) and self.IsItemEnabled(self._current):
|
|
# expand all
|
|
self.ExpandAll(self._current)
|
|
|
|
elif keyCode in [ord("-"), wx.WXK_SUBTRACT]: # "-"
|
|
if self.IsExpanded(self._current):
|
|
self.Collapse(self._current)
|
|
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_MENU:
|
|
# Use the item's bounding rectangle to determine position for the event
|
|
itemRect = self.GetBoundingRect(self._current, True)
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_MENU, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = self._current
|
|
# Use the left edge, vertical middle
|
|
event._pointDrag = wx.Point(itemRect.GetX(), itemRect.GetY() + itemRect.GetHeight()//2)
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
elif keyCode in [wx.WXK_RETURN, wx.WXK_SPACE, wx.WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER]:
|
|
|
|
if not self.IsItemEnabled(self._current):
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if not event.HasModifiers():
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = self._current
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
if keyCode == wx.WXK_SPACE and self.GetItemType(self._current) > 0:
|
|
if self.IsItem3State(self._current):
|
|
checked = self.GetItem3StateValue(self._current)
|
|
checked = (checked+1)%3
|
|
else:
|
|
checked = not self.IsItemChecked(self._current)
|
|
|
|
self.CheckItem(self._current, checked)
|
|
|
|
if self.IsItemHyperText(self._current):
|
|
self.HandleHyperLink(self._current)
|
|
|
|
# in any case, also generate the normal key event for this key,
|
|
# even if we generated the ACTIVATED event above: this is what
|
|
# wxMSW does and it makes sense because you might not want to
|
|
# process ACTIVATED event at all and handle Space and Return
|
|
# directly (and differently) which would be impossible otherwise
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
# up goes to the previous sibling or to the last
|
|
# of its children if it's expanded
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_UP:
|
|
prev = self.GetPrevSibling(self._key_current)
|
|
if not prev:
|
|
prev = self.GetItemParent(self._key_current)
|
|
if prev == self.GetRootItem() and self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if prev:
|
|
current = self._key_current
|
|
# TODO: Huh? If we get here, we'd better be the first child of our parent. How else could it be?
|
|
if current == self.GetFirstChild(prev)[0] and self.IsItemEnabled(prev):
|
|
# otherwise we return to where we came from
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(prev, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
self._key_current = prev
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
current = self._key_current
|
|
|
|
# We are going to another parent node
|
|
while self.IsExpanded(prev) and self.HasChildren(prev):
|
|
child = self.GetLastChild(prev)
|
|
if child:
|
|
prev = child
|
|
current = prev
|
|
|
|
# Try to get the previous siblings and see if they are active
|
|
while prev and not self.IsItemEnabled(prev):
|
|
prev = self.GetPrevSibling(prev)
|
|
|
|
if not prev:
|
|
# No previous siblings active: go to the parent and up
|
|
prev = self.GetItemParent(current)
|
|
while prev and not self.IsItemEnabled(prev):
|
|
prev = self.GetItemParent(prev)
|
|
|
|
if prev:
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(prev, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
self._key_current = prev
|
|
|
|
# left arrow goes to the parent
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_LEFT:
|
|
|
|
prev = self.GetItemParent(self._current)
|
|
if prev == self.GetRootItem() and self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
# don't go to root if it is hidden
|
|
prev = self.GetPrevSibling(self._current)
|
|
|
|
if self.IsExpanded(self._current):
|
|
self.Collapse(self._current)
|
|
else:
|
|
if prev and self.IsItemEnabled(prev):
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(prev, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_RIGHT:
|
|
# this works the same as the down arrow except that we
|
|
# also expand the item if it wasn't expanded yet
|
|
if self.IsExpanded(self._current) and self.HasChildren(self._current):
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(self._key_current)
|
|
if self.IsItemEnabled(child):
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(child, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
self._key_current = child
|
|
else:
|
|
self.Expand(self._current)
|
|
# fall through
|
|
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_DOWN:
|
|
if self.IsExpanded(self._key_current) and self.HasChildren(self._key_current):
|
|
|
|
child = self.GetNextActiveItem(self._key_current)
|
|
|
|
if child:
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(child, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
self._key_current = child
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
next = self.GetNextSibling(self._key_current)
|
|
|
|
if not next:
|
|
current = self._key_current
|
|
while current and not next:
|
|
current = self.GetItemParent(current)
|
|
if current:
|
|
next = self.GetNextSibling(current)
|
|
if not next or not self.IsItemEnabled(next):
|
|
next = None
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
while next and not self.IsItemEnabled(next):
|
|
next = self.GetNext(next)
|
|
|
|
if next:
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(next, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
self._key_current = next
|
|
|
|
|
|
# <End> selects the last visible tree item
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_END:
|
|
|
|
last = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
|
|
while last and self.IsExpanded(last):
|
|
|
|
lastChild = self.GetLastChild(last)
|
|
|
|
# it may happen if the item was expanded but then all of
|
|
# its children have been deleted - so IsExpanded() returned
|
|
# true, but GetLastChild() returned invalid item
|
|
if not lastChild:
|
|
break
|
|
|
|
last = lastChild
|
|
|
|
if last and self.IsItemEnabled(last):
|
|
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(last, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
|
|
# <Home> selects the root item
|
|
elif keyCode == wx.WXK_HOME:
|
|
|
|
prev = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
|
|
if not prev:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
prev, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(prev)
|
|
if not prev:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self.IsItemEnabled(prev):
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(prev, unselect_others, extended_select, from_key=True)
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
if not event.HasModifiers() and ((keyCode >= ord('0') and keyCode <= ord('9')) or \
|
|
(keyCode >= ord('a') and keyCode <= ord('z')) or \
|
|
(keyCode >= ord('A') and keyCode <= ord('Z'))):
|
|
|
|
# find the next item starting with the given prefix
|
|
ch = chr(keyCode)
|
|
id = self.FindItem(self._current, self._findPrefix + ch)
|
|
|
|
if not id:
|
|
# no such item
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self.IsItemEnabled(id):
|
|
self.SelectItem(id)
|
|
self._findPrefix += ch
|
|
|
|
# also start the timer to reset the current prefix if the user
|
|
# doesn't press any more alnum keys soon -- we wouldn't want
|
|
# to use this prefix for a new item search
|
|
if not self._findTimer:
|
|
self._findTimer = TreeFindTimer(self)
|
|
|
|
self._findTimer.Start(_DELAY, wx.TIMER_ONE_SHOT)
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetNextActiveItem(self, item, down=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the next active item. Used Internally at present.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `down`: ``True`` to search downwards in the hierarchy for an active item,
|
|
``False`` to search upwards.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` if an active item has been found or
|
|
``None`` if none has been found.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if down:
|
|
sibling = self.GetNextSibling
|
|
else:
|
|
sibling = self.GetPrevSibling
|
|
|
|
if self.GetItemType(item) == 2 and not self.IsItemChecked(item):
|
|
# Is an unchecked radiobutton... all its children are inactive
|
|
# try to get the next/previous sibling
|
|
found = 0
|
|
|
|
while 1:
|
|
child = sibling(item)
|
|
if (child and self.IsItemEnabled(child)) or not child:
|
|
break
|
|
item = child
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
# Tha's not a radiobutton... but some of its children can be
|
|
# inactive
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(item)
|
|
while child and not self.IsItemEnabled(child):
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
if child and self.IsItemEnabled(child):
|
|
return child
|
|
|
|
return None
|
|
|
|
|
|
def HitTest(self, point, flags=0):
|
|
"""
|
|
Calculates which (if any) item is under the given point, returning the tree item
|
|
at this point plus extra information flags.
|
|
|
|
:param `point`: an instance of :class:`Point`, a point to test for hits;
|
|
:param integer `flags`: a bitlist of the following values:
|
|
|
|
================================== =============== =================================
|
|
HitTest Flags Hex Value Description
|
|
================================== =============== =================================
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ABOVE`` 0x1 Above the client area
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_BELOW`` 0x2 Below the client area
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_NOWHERE`` 0x4 No item has been hit
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMBUTTON`` 0x8 On the button associated to an item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMICON`` 0x10 On the icon associated to an item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMINDENT`` 0x20 On the indent associated to an item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL`` 0x40 On the label (string) associated to an item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM`` 0x50 Anywhere on the item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMRIGHT`` 0x80 On the right of the label associated to an item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_TOLEFT`` 0x200 On the left of the client area
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_TORIGHT`` 0x400 On the right of the client area
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMUPPERPART`` 0x800 On the upper part (first half) of the item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLOWERPART`` 0x1000 On the lower part (second half) of the item
|
|
``TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMCHECKICON`` 0x2000 On the check/radio icon, if present
|
|
================================== =============== =================================
|
|
|
|
:return: A tuple with the first value being an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem` or ``None`` if
|
|
no item has been hit-tested, and as second value an integer parameter `flag`.
|
|
|
|
:note: both the item (if any, ``None`` otherwise) and the `flags` are always returned as a tuple.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
w, h = self.GetSize()
|
|
flags = 0
|
|
|
|
pointX, pointY = point[0], point[1]
|
|
if pointX < 0:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_TOLEFT
|
|
if pointX > w:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_TORIGHT
|
|
if pointY < 0:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_ABOVE
|
|
if pointY > h:
|
|
flags |= TREE_HITTEST_BELOW
|
|
|
|
if flags:
|
|
return None, flags
|
|
|
|
if self._anchor == None:
|
|
flags = TREE_HITTEST_NOWHERE
|
|
return None, flags
|
|
|
|
point = self.CalcUnscrolledPosition(*point)
|
|
hit, flags = self._anchor.HitTest(point, self, flags, 0)
|
|
|
|
if hit == None:
|
|
flags = TREE_HITTEST_NOWHERE
|
|
return None, flags
|
|
|
|
if not self.IsItemEnabled(hit):
|
|
return None, flags
|
|
|
|
return hit, flags
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetBoundingRect(self, item, textOnly=False):
|
|
"""
|
|
Retrieves the rectangle bounding the item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param bool `textOnly`: if ``True``, only the rectangle around the item's label will
|
|
be returned, otherwise the item's image is also taken into account.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Rect`.
|
|
|
|
:note: The rectangle coordinates are logical, not physical ones. So, for example,
|
|
the `x` coordinate may be negative if the tree has a horizontal scrollbar and its
|
|
position is not ``0``.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
i = item
|
|
|
|
startX, startY = self.GetViewStart()
|
|
rect = wx.Rect()
|
|
|
|
rect.x = i.GetX() - startX*_PIXELS_PER_UNIT
|
|
rect.y = i.GetY() - startY*_PIXELS_PER_UNIT
|
|
rect.width = i.GetWidth()
|
|
rect.height = self.GetLineHeight(i)
|
|
|
|
return rect
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Edit(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Internal function. Starts the editing of an item label, sending a
|
|
``EVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT`` event.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
|
|
.. warning:: Separator-type items can not be edited.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSeparator():
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
te = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_BEGIN_LABEL_EDIT, self.GetId())
|
|
te._item = item
|
|
te.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(te) and not te.IsAllowed():
|
|
# vetoed by user
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
# We have to call this here because the label in
|
|
# question might just have been added and no screen
|
|
# update taken place.
|
|
if self._dirty:
|
|
if wx.Platform in ["__WXMSW__", "__WXMAC__"]:
|
|
self.Update()
|
|
else:
|
|
wx.SafeYield()
|
|
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and item != self._editCtrl.item():
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
|
|
self._editCtrl = TreeTextCtrl(self, item=item)
|
|
self._editCtrl.SetFocus()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetEditControl(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns a pointer to the edit :class:`TreeTextCtrl` if the item is being edited or
|
|
``None`` otherwise (it is assumed that no more than one item may be edited
|
|
simultaneously).
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
return self._editCtrl
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnAcceptEdit(self, item, value):
|
|
"""
|
|
Called by :class:`TreeTextCtrl`, to accept the changes and to send the
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` event.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param string `value`: the new value of the item label.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``True`` if the editing has not been vetoed, ``False`` otherwise.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
le = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT, self.GetId())
|
|
le._item = item
|
|
le.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
le._label = value
|
|
le._editCancelled = False
|
|
|
|
return not self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(le) or le.IsAllowed()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnCancelEdit(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Called by :class:`TreeTextCtrl`, to cancel the changes and to send the
|
|
``EVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT`` event.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# let owner know that the edit was cancelled
|
|
le = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_END_LABEL_EDIT, self.GetId())
|
|
le._item = item
|
|
le.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
le._label = ""
|
|
le._editCancelled = True
|
|
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(le)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnEditTimer(self):
|
|
""" The timer for editing has expired. Start editing. """
|
|
|
|
self.Edit(self._current)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnMouse(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Handles a bunch of ``wx.EVT_MOUSE_EVENTS`` events for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`MouseEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not self._anchor:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
pt = wx.Point(self.CalcUnscrolledPosition(*event.GetPosition()))
|
|
|
|
# Is the mouse over a tree item button?
|
|
flags = 0
|
|
thisItem, flags = self._anchor.HitTest(pt, self, flags, 0)
|
|
underMouse = thisItem
|
|
underMouseChanged = underMouse != self._underMouse
|
|
|
|
if underMouse and (flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM) and not event.LeftIsDown() and \
|
|
not self._isDragging and (not self._editTimer or not self._editTimer.IsRunning()):
|
|
underMouse = underMouse
|
|
else:
|
|
underMouse = None
|
|
|
|
if underMouse != self._underMouse:
|
|
if self._underMouse:
|
|
# unhighlight old item
|
|
self._underMouse = None
|
|
|
|
self._underMouse = underMouse
|
|
|
|
# Determines what item we are hovering over and need a tooltip for
|
|
hoverItem = thisItem
|
|
|
|
# We do not want a tooltip if we are dragging, or if the edit timer is running
|
|
if underMouseChanged and not self._isDragging and (not self._editTimer or not self._editTimer.IsRunning()):
|
|
|
|
if hoverItem is not None:
|
|
# Ask the tree control what tooltip (if any) should be shown
|
|
hevent = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_GETTOOLTIP, self.GetId())
|
|
hevent._item = hoverItem
|
|
hevent.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(hevent) and hevent.IsAllowed():
|
|
self.SetToolTip(hevent._label)
|
|
|
|
elif self.HasAGWFlag(TR_TOOLTIP_ON_LONG_ITEMS):
|
|
|
|
tip = self.GetToolTipText()
|
|
|
|
if hoverItem.IsSeparator():
|
|
if tip:
|
|
self.SetToolTip('')
|
|
else:
|
|
maxsize = self.GetItemSize(hoverItem)
|
|
itemText = hoverItem.GetText()
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
|
|
if dc.GetFullMultiLineTextExtent(itemText)[0] > maxsize:
|
|
if tip != itemText:
|
|
self.SetToolTip(itemText)
|
|
else:
|
|
if tip:
|
|
self.SetToolTip('')
|
|
|
|
if hoverItem.IsHyperText() and (flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL) and hoverItem.IsEnabled():
|
|
self.SetCursor(wx.Cursor(wx.CURSOR_HAND))
|
|
self._isonhyperlink = True
|
|
else:
|
|
if self._isonhyperlink:
|
|
self.SetCursor(wx.Cursor(wx.CURSOR_ARROW))
|
|
self._isonhyperlink = False
|
|
|
|
# we process left mouse up event (enables in-place edit), right down
|
|
# (pass to the user code), left dbl click (activate item) and
|
|
# dragging/moving events for items drag-and-drop
|
|
|
|
if not (event.LeftDown() or event.LeftUp() or event.RightDown() or event.LeftDClick() or \
|
|
event.Dragging() or ((event.Moving() or event.RightUp()) and self._isDragging)):
|
|
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
flags = 0
|
|
item, flags = self._anchor.HitTest(pt, self, flags, 0)
|
|
|
|
if event.Dragging() and not self._isDragging and ((flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMICON) or (flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL)):
|
|
|
|
if self._dragCount == 0:
|
|
self._dragStart = pt
|
|
|
|
self._countDrag = 0
|
|
self._dragCount = self._dragCount + 1
|
|
|
|
if self._dragCount != 3:
|
|
# wait until user drags a bit further...
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
command = (event.RightIsDown() and [wxEVT_TREE_BEGIN_RDRAG] or [wxEVT_TREE_BEGIN_DRAG])[0]
|
|
|
|
nevent = TreeEvent(command, self.GetId())
|
|
nevent._item = self._current
|
|
nevent.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
newpt = self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt)
|
|
nevent.SetPoint(newpt)
|
|
|
|
# by default the dragging is not supported, the user code must
|
|
# explicitly allow the event for it to take place
|
|
nevent.Veto()
|
|
|
|
if self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(nevent) and nevent.IsAllowed():
|
|
|
|
# we're going to drag this item
|
|
self._isDragging = True
|
|
|
|
# remember the old cursor because we will change it while
|
|
# dragging
|
|
self._oldCursor = self._cursor
|
|
|
|
# in a single selection control, hide the selection temporarily
|
|
if not (self.GetAGWWindowStyleFlag() & TR_MULTIPLE):
|
|
self._oldSelection = self.GetSelection()
|
|
|
|
if self._oldSelection:
|
|
|
|
self._oldSelection.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._oldSelection)
|
|
else:
|
|
selections = self.GetSelections()
|
|
if len(selections) == 1:
|
|
self._oldSelection = selections[0]
|
|
self._oldSelection.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._oldSelection)
|
|
|
|
if self._dragImage:
|
|
del self._dragImage
|
|
|
|
# Create the custom draw image from the icons and the text of the item
|
|
self._dragImage = DragImage(self, self._current)
|
|
self._dragImage.BeginDrag(wx.Point(0,0), self)
|
|
self._dragImage.Show()
|
|
self._dragImage.Move(self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt))
|
|
|
|
elif event.Dragging() and self._isDragging:
|
|
|
|
self._dragImage.Move(self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt))
|
|
|
|
if self._countDrag == 0 and item:
|
|
self._oldItem = item
|
|
|
|
if item != self._dropTarget:
|
|
|
|
# unhighlight the previous drop target
|
|
if self._dropTarget:
|
|
self._dropTarget.SetHilight(False)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._dropTarget)
|
|
if item:
|
|
item.SetHilight(True)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
self._countDrag = self._countDrag + 1
|
|
self._dropTarget = item
|
|
|
|
self.Update()
|
|
|
|
if self._countDrag >= 3:
|
|
# Here I am trying to avoid ugly repainting problems... hope it works
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._oldItem)
|
|
self._countDrag = 0
|
|
|
|
elif (event.LeftUp() or event.RightUp()) and self._isDragging:
|
|
|
|
if self._dragImage:
|
|
self._dragImage.EndDrag()
|
|
|
|
if self._dropTarget:
|
|
self._dropTarget.SetHilight(False)
|
|
|
|
if self._oldSelection:
|
|
|
|
self._oldSelection.SetHilight(True)
|
|
self.RefreshLine(self._oldSelection)
|
|
self._oldSelection = None
|
|
|
|
# generate the drag end event
|
|
event = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_END_DRAG, self.GetId())
|
|
event._item = item
|
|
event._pointDrag = self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt)
|
|
event.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(event)
|
|
|
|
self._isDragging = False
|
|
self._dropTarget = None
|
|
|
|
self.SetCursor(self._oldCursor)
|
|
|
|
if wx.Platform in ["__WXMSW__", "__WXMAC__"]:
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
else:
|
|
# Probably this is not enough on GTK. Try a Refresh() if it does not work.
|
|
wx.SafeYield()
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
# If we got to this point, we are not dragging or moving the mouse.
|
|
# Because the code in carbon/toplevel.cpp will only set focus to the tree
|
|
# if we skip for EVT_LEFT_DOWN, we MUST skip this event here for focus to work.
|
|
# We skip even if we didn't hit an item because we still should
|
|
# restore focus to the tree control even if we didn't exactly hit an item.
|
|
if event.LeftDown():
|
|
self._hasFocus = True
|
|
self.SetFocusIgnoringChildren()
|
|
event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
# here we process only the messages which happen on tree items
|
|
|
|
self._dragCount = 0
|
|
|
|
if item == None:
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and item != self._editCtrl.item():
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
return # we hit the blank area
|
|
|
|
if event.RightDown():
|
|
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and item != self._editCtrl.item():
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
|
|
self._hasFocus = True
|
|
self.SetFocusIgnoringChildren()
|
|
|
|
# If the item is already selected, do not update the selection.
|
|
# Multi-selections should not be cleared if a selected item is clicked.
|
|
if not self.IsSelected(item):
|
|
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(item, True, False)
|
|
|
|
nevent = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_RIGHT_CLICK, self.GetId())
|
|
nevent._item = item
|
|
nevent._pointDrag = self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt)
|
|
nevent.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
event.Skip(not self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(nevent))
|
|
|
|
# Consistent with MSW (for now), send the ITEM_MENU *after*
|
|
# the RIGHT_CLICK event. TODO: This behaviour may change.
|
|
nevent2 = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_MENU, self.GetId())
|
|
nevent2._item = item
|
|
nevent2._pointDrag = self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt)
|
|
nevent2.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(nevent2)
|
|
|
|
elif event.LeftUp():
|
|
|
|
# this facilitates multiple-item drag-and-drop
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE):
|
|
|
|
selections = self.GetSelections()
|
|
|
|
if len(selections) > 1 and not event.CmdDown() and not event.ShiftDown():
|
|
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(item, True, False)
|
|
|
|
if self._lastOnSame:
|
|
|
|
if item == self._current and (flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL) and self.HasAGWFlag(TR_EDIT_LABELS):
|
|
|
|
if self._editTimer:
|
|
|
|
if self._editTimer.IsRunning():
|
|
|
|
self._editTimer.Stop()
|
|
|
|
else:
|
|
|
|
self._editTimer = TreeEditTimer(self)
|
|
|
|
self._editTimer.Start(_DELAY, True)
|
|
|
|
self._lastOnSame = False
|
|
|
|
|
|
else: # !RightDown() && !LeftUp() ==> LeftDown() || LeftDClick()
|
|
|
|
if not item or not item.IsEnabled():
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and item != self._editCtrl.item():
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if self._editCtrl != None and item != self._editCtrl.item():
|
|
self._editCtrl.StopEditing()
|
|
|
|
self._hasFocus = True
|
|
self.SetFocusIgnoringChildren()
|
|
|
|
if event.LeftDown():
|
|
|
|
self._lastOnSame = item == self._current
|
|
|
|
if flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMBUTTON:
|
|
|
|
# only toggle the item for a single click, double click on
|
|
# the button doesn't do anything (it toggles the item twice)
|
|
if event.LeftDown():
|
|
|
|
self.Toggle(item)
|
|
|
|
# don't select the item if the button was clicked
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if item.GetType() > 0 and (flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMCHECKICON) and (flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEMLABEL == 0):
|
|
|
|
if event.LeftDown():
|
|
if flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM and self.HasAGWFlag(TR_FULL_ROW_HIGHLIGHT):
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(item, not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE))
|
|
|
|
if self.IsItem3State(item):
|
|
checked = self.GetItem3StateValue(item)
|
|
checked = (checked+1)%3
|
|
else:
|
|
checked = not self.IsItemChecked(item)
|
|
|
|
self.CheckItem(item, checked)
|
|
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
# clear the previously selected items, if the
|
|
# user clicked outside of the present selection.
|
|
# otherwise, perform the deselection on mouse-up.
|
|
# this allows multiple drag and drop to work.
|
|
# but if Cmd is down, toggle selection of the clicked item
|
|
if not self.IsSelected(item) or event.CmdDown():
|
|
|
|
if flags & TREE_HITTEST_ONITEM:
|
|
# how should the selection work for this event?
|
|
if item.IsHyperText():
|
|
self.SetItemVisited(item, True)
|
|
|
|
is_multiple, extended_select, unselect_others = EventFlagsToSelType(self.GetAGWWindowStyleFlag(),
|
|
event.ShiftDown(),
|
|
event.CmdDown())
|
|
|
|
self.DoSelectItem(item, unselect_others, extended_select)
|
|
|
|
# Handle hyperlink items... which are a bit odd sometimes
|
|
elif self.IsSelected(item) and item.IsHyperText():
|
|
self.HandleHyperLink(item)
|
|
|
|
# For some reason, Windows isn't recognizing a left double-click,
|
|
# so we need to simulate it here. Allow 200 milliseconds for now.
|
|
if event.LeftDClick():
|
|
|
|
# double clicking should not start editing the item label
|
|
if self._editTimer:
|
|
self._editTimer.Stop()
|
|
|
|
self._lastOnSame = False
|
|
|
|
# send activate event first
|
|
nevent = TreeEvent(wxEVT_TREE_ITEM_ACTIVATED, self.GetId())
|
|
nevent._item = item
|
|
nevent._pointDrag = self.CalcScrolledPosition(*pt)
|
|
nevent.SetEventObject(self)
|
|
if not self.GetEventHandler().ProcessEvent(nevent):
|
|
|
|
# if the user code didn't process the activate event,
|
|
# handle it ourselves by toggling the item when it is
|
|
# double clicked
|
|
## if item.HasPlus():
|
|
self.Toggle(item)
|
|
|
|
#TODO/Bug?: Temp Hack - MCow. Phoenix after rightclick menu item gets set to white or background colour
|
|
# and becomes invisible. Set to black in meantime
|
|
self.SetItemTextColour(thisItem, wx.BLACK) #self.GetItemTextColour(thisItem)
|
|
|
|
def OnInternalIdle(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
This method is normally only used internally, but sometimes an application
|
|
may need it to implement functionality that should not be disabled by an
|
|
application defining an `OnIdle` handler in a derived class.
|
|
|
|
This method may be used to do delayed painting, for example, and most
|
|
implementations call :meth:`Window.UpdateWindowUI` in order to send update events
|
|
to the window in idle time.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# Check if we need to select the root item
|
|
# because nothing else has been selected.
|
|
# Delaying it means that we can invoke event handlers
|
|
# as required, when a first item is selected.
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_MULTIPLE) and not self.GetSelection():
|
|
|
|
if self._select_me:
|
|
self.SelectItem(self._select_me)
|
|
elif self.GetRootItem():
|
|
self.SelectItem(self.GetRootItem())
|
|
|
|
# after all changes have been done to the tree control,
|
|
# we actually redraw the tree when everything is over
|
|
|
|
if not self._dirty:
|
|
return
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
self._dirty = False
|
|
|
|
self.CalculatePositions()
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
self.AdjustMyScrollbars()
|
|
|
|
# event.Skip()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CalculateSize(self, item, dc, level=-1, align=0):
|
|
"""
|
|
Calculates overall position and size of an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param integer `level`: the item level in the tree hierarchy;
|
|
:param integer `align`: an integer specifying the alignment type:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`align` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 No horizontal alignment of windows (in items with windows).
|
|
1 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the same horizontal position.
|
|
2 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
attr = item.GetAttributes()
|
|
|
|
if attr and attr.HasFont():
|
|
dc.SetFont(attr.GetFont())
|
|
else:
|
|
if item.IsBold():
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._boldFont)
|
|
elif item.IsItalic():
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._italicFont)
|
|
else:
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._normalFont)
|
|
|
|
text_w, text_h, dummy = dc.GetFullMultiLineTextExtent(item.GetText())
|
|
text_h+=2
|
|
|
|
# restore normal font
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._normalFont)
|
|
|
|
image_w, image_h = 0, 0
|
|
image = item.GetCurrentImage()
|
|
|
|
if image != _NO_IMAGE:
|
|
|
|
if self._imageListNormal:
|
|
|
|
image_w, image_h = self._imageListNormal.GetSize(image)
|
|
image_w += 4
|
|
|
|
total_h = ((image_h > text_h) and [image_h] or [text_h])[0]
|
|
|
|
checkimage = item.GetCurrentCheckedImage()
|
|
if checkimage is not None:
|
|
wcheck, hcheck = self._imageListCheck.GetSize(checkimage)
|
|
wcheck += 4
|
|
else:
|
|
wcheck = 0
|
|
|
|
if total_h < 30:
|
|
total_h += 2 # at least 2 pixels
|
|
else:
|
|
total_h += total_h//10 # otherwise 10% extra spacing
|
|
|
|
if total_h > self._lineHeight:
|
|
self._lineHeight = total_h
|
|
|
|
wnd = item.GetWindow()
|
|
if not wnd:
|
|
totalWidth = image_w+text_w+wcheck+2
|
|
totalHeight = total_h
|
|
else:
|
|
totalWidth = item.GetWindowSize()[0]+image_w+text_w+wcheck+2
|
|
totalHeight = max(total_h, item.GetWindowSize()[1])
|
|
|
|
if level >= 0 and wnd:
|
|
if align == 0:
|
|
if level in self.absoluteWindows:
|
|
self.absoluteWindows[level] = max(self.absoluteWindows[level], image_w+text_w+wcheck+2)
|
|
else:
|
|
self.absoluteWindows[level] = image_w+text_w+wcheck+2
|
|
elif align == 1:
|
|
self.absoluteWindows[level] = max(self.absoluteWindows[level], image_w+text_w+wcheck+2)
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSeparator():
|
|
totalWidth = self.GetClientSize()[0]
|
|
totalHeight = total_h
|
|
|
|
item.SetWidth(totalWidth)
|
|
item.SetHeight(totalHeight)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CalculateLevel(self, item, dc, level, y, align=0):
|
|
"""
|
|
Calculates the level of an item inside the tree hierarchy.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param `dc`: an instance of :class:`DC`;
|
|
:param integer `level`: the item level in the tree hierarchy;
|
|
:param integer `y`: the current vertical position inside the :class:`ScrolledWindow`;
|
|
:param integer `align`: an integer specifying the alignment type:
|
|
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
`align` Value Description
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
0 No horizontal alignment of windows (in items with windows).
|
|
1 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the same horizontal position.
|
|
2 Windows (in items with windows) are aligned at the rightmost edge of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
=============== =========================================
|
|
|
|
:return: The new `y` vertical position inside the :class:`ScrolledWindow`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
x = level*self._indent
|
|
|
|
if not self.HasAGWFlag(TR_HIDE_ROOT):
|
|
|
|
x += self._indent
|
|
|
|
elif level == 0:
|
|
|
|
# a hidden root is not evaluated, but its
|
|
# children are always calculated
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
count = len(children)
|
|
level = level + 1
|
|
for n in range(count):
|
|
y = self.CalculateLevel(children[n], dc, level, y, align) # recurse
|
|
|
|
return y
|
|
|
|
self.CalculateSize(item, dc, level, align)
|
|
|
|
# set its position
|
|
item.SetX(x+self._spacing)
|
|
item.SetY(y)
|
|
y += self.GetLineHeight(item)
|
|
|
|
if not item.IsExpanded():
|
|
# we don't need to calculate collapsed branches
|
|
return y
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
count = len(children)
|
|
level = level + 1
|
|
for n in range(count):
|
|
y = self.CalculateLevel(children[n], dc, level, y, align) # recurse
|
|
|
|
return y
|
|
|
|
|
|
def CalculatePositions(self):
|
|
""" Calculates all the positions of the visible items. """
|
|
|
|
if not self._anchor:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
self.absoluteWindows = {}
|
|
|
|
dc = wx.ClientDC(self)
|
|
self.PrepareDC(dc)
|
|
|
|
dc.SetFont(self._normalFont)
|
|
dc.SetPen(self._dottedPen)
|
|
y = 2
|
|
y = self.CalculateLevel(self._anchor, dc, 0, y) # start recursion
|
|
|
|
if self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS) or self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT):
|
|
align = (self.HasAGWFlag(TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS) and [1] or [2])[0]
|
|
y = 2
|
|
y = self.CalculateLevel(self._anchor, dc, 0, y, align) # start recursion
|
|
|
|
|
|
def RefreshSubtree(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Refreshes a damaged subtree of an item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._dirty:
|
|
return
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
client = self.GetClientSize()
|
|
|
|
rect = wx.Rect()
|
|
x, rect.y = self.CalcScrolledPosition(0, item.GetY())
|
|
rect.width = client.x
|
|
rect.height = client.y
|
|
|
|
self.Refresh(True, rect)
|
|
self.AdjustMyScrollbars()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def RefreshLine(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Refreshes a damaged item line.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._dirty:
|
|
return
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
rect = wx.Rect()
|
|
x, rect.y = self.CalcScrolledPosition(0, item.GetY())
|
|
rect.width = self.GetClientSize().x
|
|
rect.height = self.GetLineHeight(item)
|
|
|
|
self.Refresh(True, rect)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def RefreshSelected(self):
|
|
""" Refreshes a damaged selected item line. """
|
|
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
# TODO: this is awfully inefficient, we should keep the list of all
|
|
# selected items internally, should be much faster
|
|
if self._anchor:
|
|
self.RefreshSelectedUnder(self._anchor)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def RefreshSelectedUnder(self, item):
|
|
"""
|
|
Refreshes the selected items under the given item.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if item.IsSelected():
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
for child in children:
|
|
self.RefreshSelectedUnder(child)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def RefreshItemWithWindows(self, item=None):
|
|
"""
|
|
Refreshes the items with which a window is associated.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`. If `item` is ``None``, then the
|
|
recursive refresh starts from the root node.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is called only if the style ``TR_ALIGN_WINDOWS_RIGHT`` is used.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
if item is None:
|
|
if self._anchor:
|
|
self.RefreshItemWithWindows(self._anchor)
|
|
return
|
|
|
|
wnd = item.GetWindow()
|
|
if wnd and wnd.IsShown():
|
|
self.RefreshLine(item)
|
|
|
|
children = item.GetChildren()
|
|
for child in children:
|
|
self.RefreshItemWithWindows(child)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Freeze(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Freeze :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
Freezes the window or, in other words, prevents any updates from taking place
|
|
on screen, the window is not redrawn at all. :meth:`~Thaw` must be called to reenable
|
|
window redrawing. Calls to these two functions may be nested.
|
|
|
|
:note: This method is useful for visual appearance optimization (for example,
|
|
it is a good idea to use it before doing many large text insertions in a row
|
|
into a :class:`TextCtrl` under wxGTK) but is not implemented on all platforms nor
|
|
for all controls so it is mostly just a hint to wxWidgets and not a mandatory
|
|
directive.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self._freezeCount = self._freezeCount + 1
|
|
|
|
|
|
def Thaw(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Thaw :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
Reenables window updating after a previous call to :meth:`~Freeze`. To really thaw the
|
|
control, it must be called exactly the same number of times as :meth:`~Freeze`.
|
|
|
|
:raise: `Exception` if :meth:`~Thaw` has been called without an un-matching :meth:`~Freeze`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if self._freezeCount == 0:
|
|
raise Exception("\nERROR: Thawing Unfrozen Tree Control?")
|
|
|
|
self._freezeCount = self._freezeCount - 1
|
|
|
|
if not self._freezeCount:
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
# changing colours: we need to refresh the tree control
|
|
# ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
def SetBackgroundColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Changes the background colour of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: the colour to be used as the background colour, pass
|
|
:class:`NullColour` to reset to the default colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``False`` if the underlying :class:`ScrolledWindow` does not accept
|
|
the new colour, ``True`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: The background colour is usually painted by the default :class:`EraseEvent`
|
|
event handler function under Windows and automatically under GTK.
|
|
|
|
:note: Setting the background colour does not cause an immediate refresh, so
|
|
you may wish to call :meth:`Window.ClearBackground` or :meth:`Window.Refresh` after
|
|
calling this function.
|
|
|
|
:note: Overridden from :class:`ScrolledWindow`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not wx.ScrolledWindow.SetBackgroundColour(self, colour):
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def SetForegroundColour(self, colour):
|
|
"""
|
|
Changes the foreground colour of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param `colour`: the colour to be used as the foreground colour, pass
|
|
:class:`NullColour` to reset to the default colour.
|
|
|
|
:return: ``False`` if the underlying :class:`ScrolledWindow` does not accept
|
|
the new colour, ``True`` otherwise.
|
|
|
|
:note: Overridden from :class:`ScrolledWindow`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
if not wx.ScrolledWindow.SetForegroundColour(self, colour):
|
|
return False
|
|
|
|
if self._freezeCount:
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
self.Refresh()
|
|
|
|
return True
|
|
|
|
|
|
def OnGetToolTip(self, event):
|
|
"""
|
|
Process the tooltip event, to speed up event processing. Does not actually
|
|
get a tooltip.
|
|
|
|
:param `event`: a :class:`CommandTreeEvent` event to be processed.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
event.Veto()
|
|
|
|
|
|
def DoGetBestSize(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Gets the size which best suits the window: for a control, it would be the
|
|
minimal size which doesn't truncate the control, for a panel - the same size
|
|
as it would have after a call to `Fit()`.
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`Size`.
|
|
|
|
:note: Overridden from :class:`ScrolledWindow`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
# something is better than nothing...
|
|
# 100x80 is what the MSW version will get from the default
|
|
# wxControl::DoGetBestSize
|
|
|
|
return wx.Size(100, 80)
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetMaxWidth(self, respect_expansion_state=True):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the maximum width of the :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`.
|
|
|
|
:param bool `respect_expansion_state`: if ``True``, only the expanded items (and their
|
|
children) will be measured. Otherwise all the items are expanded and
|
|
their width measured.
|
|
|
|
:return: the maximum width of :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`, in pixels.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
self.Freeze()
|
|
|
|
root = self.GetRootItem()
|
|
rect = self.GetBoundingRect(root, True)
|
|
|
|
# It looks like the space between the "+" and the node
|
|
# rect occupies 4 pixels approximatively
|
|
maxwidth = rect.x + rect.width + 4
|
|
lastheight = rect.y + rect.height
|
|
|
|
if not self.IsExpanded(root):
|
|
if respect_expansion_state:
|
|
return maxwidth
|
|
|
|
if not respect_expansion_state:
|
|
self.ExpandAll()
|
|
|
|
maxwidth, lastheight = self.RecurseOnChildren(root, maxwidth, respect_expansion_state)
|
|
|
|
self.Thaw()
|
|
|
|
return maxwidth
|
|
|
|
|
|
def RecurseOnChildren(self, item, maxwidth, respect_expansion_state):
|
|
"""
|
|
Recurses over all the children of the spcified items, calculating their
|
|
maximum width.
|
|
|
|
:param `item`: an instance of :class:`GenericTreeItem`;
|
|
:param integer `maxwidth`: the current maximum width for :class:`CustomTreeCtrl`, in pixels;
|
|
:param bool `respect_expansion_state`: if ``True``, only the expanded items (and their
|
|
children) will be measured. Otherwise all the items are expanded and
|
|
their width measured.
|
|
|
|
:return: A tuple containing the maximum width and item height, in pixels.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetFirstChild(item)
|
|
lastheight = 0
|
|
|
|
while child:
|
|
|
|
rect = self.GetBoundingRect(child, True)
|
|
|
|
# It looks like the space between the "+" and the node
|
|
# rect occupies 4 pixels approximatively
|
|
maxwidth = max(maxwidth, rect.x + rect.width + 4)
|
|
lastheight = rect.y + rect.height
|
|
|
|
if self.IsExpanded(child) or not respect_expansion_state:
|
|
maxwidth, lastheight = self.RecurseOnChildren(child, maxwidth, respect_expansion_state)
|
|
|
|
child, cookie = self.GetNextChild(item, cookie)
|
|
|
|
return maxwidth, lastheight
|
|
|
|
|
|
def GetClassDefaultAttributes(self):
|
|
"""
|
|
Returns the default font and colours which are used by the control. This is
|
|
useful if you want to use the same font or colour in your own control as in
|
|
a standard control -- which is a much better idea than hard coding specific
|
|
colours or fonts which might look completely out of place on the users system,
|
|
especially if it uses themes.
|
|
|
|
This static method is "overridden'' in many derived classes and so calling,
|
|
for example, :meth:`Button.GetClassDefaultAttributes` () will typically return the
|
|
values appropriate for a button which will be normally different from those
|
|
returned by, say, :meth:`ListCtrl.GetClassDefaultAttributes` ().
|
|
|
|
:return: An instance of :class:`VisualAttributes`.
|
|
|
|
:note: The :class:`VisualAttributes` structure has at least the fields `font`,
|
|
`colFg` and `colBg`. All of them may be invalid if it was not possible to
|
|
determine the default control appearance or, especially for the background
|
|
colour, if the field doesn't make sense as is the case for `colBg` for the
|
|
controls with themed background.
|
|
|
|
:note: Overridden from :class:`Control`.
|
|
"""
|
|
|
|
attr = wx.VisualAttributes()
|
|
attr.colFg = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_WINDOWTEXT)
|
|
attr.colBg = wx.SystemSettings.GetColour(wx.SYS_COLOUR_LISTBOX)
|
|
attr.font = wx.SystemSettings.GetFont(wx.SYS_DEFAULT_GUI_FONT)
|
|
return attr
|
|
|
|
GetClassDefaultAttributes = classmethod(GetClassDefaultAttributes)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if __name__ == '__main__':
|
|
|
|
import wx
|
|
|
|
class MyFrame(wx.Frame):
|
|
|
|
def __init__(self, parent):
|
|
|
|
wx.Frame.__init__(self, parent, -1, "CustomTreeCtrl Demo")
|
|
|
|
# Create a CustomTreeCtrl instance
|
|
custom_tree = CustomTreeCtrl(self, agwStyle=wx.TR_DEFAULT_STYLE)
|
|
custom_tree.SetBackgroundColour(wx.WHITE)
|
|
|
|
# Add a root node to it
|
|
root = custom_tree.AddRoot("The Root Item")
|
|
|
|
# Create an image list to add icons next to an item
|
|
il = wx.ImageList(16, 16)
|
|
fldridx = il.Add(wx.ArtProvider.GetBitmap(wx.ART_FOLDER, wx.ART_OTHER, (16, 16)))
|
|
fldropenidx = il.Add(wx.ArtProvider.GetBitmap(wx.ART_FILE_OPEN, wx.ART_OTHER, (16, 16)))
|
|
fileidx = il.Add(wx.ArtProvider.GetBitmap(wx.ART_NORMAL_FILE, wx.ART_OTHER, (16, 16)))
|
|
|
|
custom_tree.SetImageList(il)
|
|
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(root, fldridx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(root, fldropenidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Expanded)
|
|
|
|
for x in range(15):
|
|
child = custom_tree.AppendItem(root, "Item %d" % x)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(child, fldridx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(child, fldropenidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Expanded)
|
|
|
|
for y in range(5):
|
|
last = custom_tree.AppendItem(child, "item %d-%s" % (x, chr(ord("a")+y)))
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(last, fldridx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(last, fldropenidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Expanded)
|
|
|
|
for z in range(5):
|
|
item = custom_tree.AppendItem(last, "item %d-%s-%d" % (x, chr(ord("a")+y), z))
|
|
custom_tree.SetItemImage(item, fileidx, wx.TreeItemIcon_Normal)
|
|
|
|
custom_tree.Expand(root)
|
|
|
|
|
|
# our normal wxApp-derived class, as usual
|
|
|
|
app = wx.App(0)
|
|
|
|
frame = MyFrame(None)
|
|
app.SetTopWindow(frame)
|
|
frame.Show()
|
|
|
|
app.MainLoop()
|